88d89284c2805b0a1927dd0636c029e44f657baa
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * NAND Flash Commands:: NAND Flash Commands
77 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
78 * General Commands:: General Commands
79 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
80 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
81 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
82 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
83 * TFTP:: TFTP
84 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
85 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
86 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
87 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
88 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
89
90 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
91 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
92 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
93 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
94 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
95 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
96 @end menu
97
98 @node About
99 @unnumbered About
100 @cindex about
101
102 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
103 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
104 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
105 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
106 around the world.
107
108 @section What is OpenOCD?
109 @cindex TAP
110 @cindex JTAG
111
112 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
113 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
114 devices.
115
116 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
117 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
118 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
119 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
120 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
121 needed to hook up to the target.
122
123 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
124 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
125 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
126 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
127 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
128
129 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
130 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
131 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
132 let the development board connect directly to the debug
133 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
134
135 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
136 signaling, and is used to communicate
137 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
138 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
139 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
140 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
141 scan operations.
142
143 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
144 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
145 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
146 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
147
148 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
149 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
150 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
151 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
152
153
154 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
155 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
156 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
157
158 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
159 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
160 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
161 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
162
163 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
164 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
165 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
166 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
167 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
168
169 @section OpenOCD Web Site
170
171 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
172
173 @uref{http://openocd.sourceforge.net/}
174
175 @section Latest User's Guide:
176
177 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
178 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
179 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
180
181 @uref{http://openocd.sourceforge.net/doc/html/index.html}
182
183 PDF form is likewise published at:
184
185 @uref{http://openocd.sourceforge.net/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
186
187 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
188
189 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
190 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
191 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
192 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
193 instead of this forum.
194
195 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
196
197 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
198
199 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
200 communication between users:
201
202 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
203
204 @section OpenOCD IRC
205
206 Support can also be found on irc:
207 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
208
209 @node Developers
210 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
211 @cindex developers
212
213 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
214 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
215 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
216 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
217
218 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
219 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
220
221 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
222
223 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
224 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
225
226 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
227
228 or via http
229
230 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
231
232 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
233
234 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
235
236 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
237 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
238 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
239 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
240 needing a Git client:
241
242 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
243
244 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
245 from the repository or a snapshot.
246
247 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
248 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
249 Patches created against older versions may require additional
250 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
251
252 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
253
254 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
255 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
256 technical information about the software internals, development
257 processes, and similar documentation:
258
259 @uref{http://openocd.sourceforge.net/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
260
261 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
262 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
263 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
264
265 @section Gerrit Review System
266
267 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
268 Code Review System:
269
270 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
271
272 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
273 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
274 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
275 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
276 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
277
278 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
279 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
280 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
281 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
282 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
283
284 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
285
286 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
287 communication between developers:
288
289 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
290
291 @section OpenOCD Bug Database
292
293 During the 0.4.x release cycle the OpenOCD project team began
294 using Trac for its bug database:
295
296 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/apps/trac/openocd}
297
298
299 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
300 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
301 @cindex dongles
302 @cindex FTDI
303 @cindex wiggler
304 @cindex zy1000
305 @cindex printer port
306 @cindex USB Adapter
307 @cindex RTCK
308
309 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
310 an adapter .... [snip]
311
312 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
313 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
314 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
315 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
316 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
317 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
318 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
319
320
321 @section Choosing a Dongle
322
323 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
324
325 @enumerate
326 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
327 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
328 other ways to communicate with target devices.
329 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
330 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
331 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
332 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
333 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
334 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
335 Ethernet port needed?
336 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
337 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
338 @end enumerate
339
340 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
341
342 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
343 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
344 running on the developer's host computer.
345 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
346 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
347 IP address assigned to the probe.
348 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
349 OpenOCD debugger.
350 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
351 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
352 the target.
353 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
354 to power cycle the target remotely.
355
356 For more information, visit:
357
358 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
359
360 @section USB FT2232 Based
361
362 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
363 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
364 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
365 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
366 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
367 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
368 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
369 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
370 clocking.)
371
372 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
373 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
374 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
375 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
376 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
377
378 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
379 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
380
381 @itemize @bullet
382 @item @b{usbjtag}
383 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
384 @item @b{jtagkey}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
386 @item @b{jtagkey2}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
388 @item @b{oocdlink}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
390 @item @b{signalyzer}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
392 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
393 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
394 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
395 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
396 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
397 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
398 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
399 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
400 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
401 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
402 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
403 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
405 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
406 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
407 @item @b{turtelizer2}
408 @* See:
409 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
410 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
411 @item @b{comstick}
412 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
413 @item @b{stm32stick}
414 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
415 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
416 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
417 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
418 @item @b{cortino}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
420 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
422 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
423 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
424 @item @b{opendous}
425 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
426 (OpenHardware).
427 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
428 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
429
430 @item @b{GW16042}
431 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
432 FT2232H-based
433
434 @end itemize
435 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
436
437 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
438 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
439 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
440 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
441 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
442
443 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
444 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
445 (see the section on driver commands).
446
447 @itemize
448 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
449 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
450 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
451 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
452 @end itemize
453
454 @section USB JLINK based
455 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
456 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
457 AT91SAM764 internally.
458
459 @itemize @bullet
460 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
462 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
463 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
464 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
466 @end itemize
467
468 @section USB RLINK based
469 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
470 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
471 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
472
473 @itemize @bullet
474 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
476 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
477 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
478 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
479 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
480 @end itemize
481
482 @section USB ST-LINK based
483 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
484 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
485
486 @itemize @bullet
487 @item @b{ST-LINK}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
490 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537 @end itemize
538
539 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
540
541 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
542 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
543 these on the market.
544
545 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
546 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
547 of USB-based ones.
548
549 @itemize @bullet
550
551 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
552 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
553
554 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
555 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
556 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
557
558 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler2}
562 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
563
564 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
565 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
566
567 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
568 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
569
570 @item @b{arm-jtag}
571 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
572
573 @item @b{chameleon}
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
575
576 @item @b{Triton}
577 @* Unknown.
578
579 @item @b{Lattice}
580 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
581 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
582
583 @item @b{flashlink}
584 @* From ST Microsystems;
585 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
586
587 @end itemize
588
589 @section Other...
590 @itemize @bullet
591
592 @item @b{ep93xx}
593 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
594
595 @item @b{at91rm9200}
596 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
597
598 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
599 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
600
601 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
602 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
603 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
604
605 @end itemize
606
607 @node About Jim-Tcl
608 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex Jim-Tcl
610 @cindex tcl
611
612 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
613 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
614 command interpreter.
615
616 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
617 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
618 much of anything about Tcl.
619 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
620
621 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
622 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
623 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
624 OpenOCD mailing list.
625
626 @itemize @bullet
627 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
628 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
629 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
630 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
631 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
632 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
633
634 @item @b{Missing Features}
635 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
636 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
637 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
638 enabled in OpenOCD.
639
640 @item @b{Scripts}
641 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
642 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
643 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
644
645 @item @b{Commands}
646 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
647 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
648 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
649 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
650
651 @item @b{Historical Note}
652 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
653 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
654 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
655 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
656
657 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
658 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
659 @end itemize
660
661 @node Running
662 @chapter Running
663 @cindex command line options
664 @cindex logfile
665 @cindex directory search
666
667 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
668 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
669 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
670 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
671 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
672 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
673 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
674
675 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
676 tell it how each debug session should work.
677 The @option{--help} option shows:
678 @verbatim
679 bash$ openocd --help
680
681 --help | -h display this help
682 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
683 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
684 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
685 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
686 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
687 --command | -c run <command>
688 @end verbatim
689
690 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
691 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
692 To specify one or more different
693 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
694
695 @example
696 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
697 @end example
698
699 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
700 @enumerate
701 @item the current directory,
702 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
703 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
704 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
705 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
706 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
707 @end enumerate
708 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
709
710 @quotation Note
711 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
712 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
713 @end quotation
714
715 @section Simple setup, no customization
716
717 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
718 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
719 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
720 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
721 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
722
723 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
724 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
725 the server with some variation of one of the following:
726
727 @example
728 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
729 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
730 @end example
731
732 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
733 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
734 If all goes well you'll see output something like
735
736 @example
737 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
738 For bug reports, read
739 http://openocd.sourceforge.net/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
740 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
741 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
742 @end example
743
744 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
745 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
746 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
747
748 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
749
750 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
751 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
752 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
753 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
754 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
755 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
756 ensure that this always succeeds.
757 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
758 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
759 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
760 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
761
762 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
763 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
764 those channels.
765
766 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
767 the @option{-d} option.
768
769 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
770 @option{-c} command line switch.
771
772 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
773 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
774 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
775 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
776 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
777 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
778 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
779
780 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
781 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
782
783 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
784 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
785 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
786 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
787
788 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
789 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
790
791 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
792 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
793 and start the OpenOCD server.
794 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
795 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
796 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
797 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
798
799 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
800
801 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
802 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
803 and a USB cable on the other.
804 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
805 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
806
807 @enumerate
808 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
809 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
810 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
811 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
812 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
813 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
814 debugging host.
815
816 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
817 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
818 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
819 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
820 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
821
822 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
823 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
824 with 1.2 Volt boards.
825
826 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
827 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
828 ways to connect the cable.
829 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
830 Be sure it's firmly connected.
831
832 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
833 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
834 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
835 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
836 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
837 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
838 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
839 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
840
841 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
842 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
843 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
844 but are tedious to set up.
845 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
846 adapter signals to the right board pins.
847
848 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
849 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
850 you are using to run OpenOCD.
851 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
852
853 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
854 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
855 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
856 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
857
858 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
859 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
860 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
861
862 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
863 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
864 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
865 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
866
867 @end enumerate
868
869 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
870 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
871 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
872
873 @section Project Directory
874
875 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
876
877 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
878 single directory for your work with a given board.
879 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
880 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
881 files accessed through semihosting,
882 and for code you upload to the target board.
883 It is also the natural place to write files,
884 such as log files and data you download from the board.
885
886 @section Configuration Basics
887
888 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
889 a variety of ways you can mix them.
890 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
891
892 @itemize
893 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
894 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
895 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
896 @end itemize
897
898 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
899 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
900 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
901
902 @example
903 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
904
905 # GDB can also flash my flash!
906 gdb_memory_map enable
907 gdb_flash_program enable
908
909 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
910 @end example
911
912 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
913
914 @example
915 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
916 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
917 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
918 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
919 @end example
920
921 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
922 each supporting a different development task.
923 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
924 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
925
926 @quotation Important
927 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
928 problems with how it treats variables.
929 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
930 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
931 that can be tested in a later script.
932 @end quotation
933
934 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
935 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
936 to simplify your work.
937
938 @section User Config Files
939 @cindex config file, user
940 @cindex user config file
941 @cindex config file, overview
942
943 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
944 in one place.
945 One of the following will match your situation best:
946
947 @itemize
948 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
949 provided by someone else.
950 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
951 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
952 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
953 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
954 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
955 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
956
957 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
958 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
959
960 @enumerate
961 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
962 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
963 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
964 @end enumerate
965
966 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
967 The first is an interface config file.
968 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
969 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
970 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
971 meet your deadline:
972
973 @example
974 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
975 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
976 @end example
977
978 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
979 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
980 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
981 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
982
983 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
984 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
985 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
986 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
987 target and board
988 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
989 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
990
991 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
992 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
993 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
994 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
995
996 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
997 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
998 giving access to your particular flash chips.
999 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1000 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
1001
1002 @quotation Note
1003 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1004 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1005 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1006 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1007 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1008 @end quotation
1009
1010 @item
1011 You may may need to write some C code.
1012 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1013 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1014 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1015 a new chip architecture.
1016 @end itemize
1017
1018 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1019 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1020 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1021
1022 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1023 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1024 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1025 @itemize
1026
1027 @item
1028 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1029 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1030 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1031 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1032
1033 @item
1034 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1035 @cindex vector_catch
1036 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1037 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1038 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1039 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1040 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1041 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1042
1043 @item
1044 You might need to override some defaults.
1045 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1046 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1047
1048 @item
1049 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1050 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1051 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1052 @end itemize
1053
1054 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1055
1056 A few project-specific utility
1057 routines may well speed up your work.
1058 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1059
1060 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1061 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1062 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1063 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1064 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1065 may help:
1066
1067 @example
1068 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1069 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1070 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1071 # Leave the CPU halted.
1072 reset init
1073
1074 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1075 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1076
1077 # Start running.
1078 resume 0x20000000
1079 @}
1080 @end example
1081
1082 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1083 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1084 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1085 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1086 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1087
1088 @example
1089 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1090 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1091 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1092 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1093 reset init
1094
1095 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1096 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1097 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1098 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1099 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1100 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1101 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1102
1103 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1104 reset run
1105 @}
1106 @end example
1107
1108 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1109 from NAND.
1110 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1111 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1112 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1113
1114 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1115 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1116
1117 @section Target Software Changes
1118
1119 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1120 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1121 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1122 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1123 handling issues like:
1124
1125 @itemize @bullet
1126
1127 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1128 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1129 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1130 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1131 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1132 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1133 your debug sessions.
1134
1135 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1136 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1137 That might however be your only option.
1138
1139 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1140 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1141 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1142 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1143 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1144 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1145 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1146 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1147 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1148 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1149 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1150 instead of the whole thing.
1151 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1152 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1153
1154 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1155 @cindex ARM semihosting
1156 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1157 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1158 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1159 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1160 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1161 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1162 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1163 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1164 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1165 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1166 NAND or SPI flash.
1167
1168 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1169 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1170 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1171 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1172 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1173
1174 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1175 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1176 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1177 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1178 registers which can be used to change various features including
1179 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1180 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1181 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1182 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1183 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1184
1185 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1186 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1187 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1188 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1189 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1190
1191 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1192 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1193 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1194 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1195 early code execution can be debugged
1196 or firmware can be replaced.
1197
1198 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1199 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1200 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1201 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1202 operations like writing to memory.)
1203
1204 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1205 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1206 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1207 various kinds of message.
1208 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1209
1210 @end itemize
1211
1212 @section Target Hardware Setup
1213
1214 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1215 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1216 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1217 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1218 working with.}
1219
1220 Common issues include:
1221
1222 @itemize @bullet
1223
1224 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1225 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1226 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1227 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1228 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1229 or one from a daughtercard).
1230 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1231 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1232
1233 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1234 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1235 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1236 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1237 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1238 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1239
1240 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1241 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1242 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1243 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1244 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1245
1246
1247 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1248 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1249 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1250 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1251 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1252 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1253 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1254
1255 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1256 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1257 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1258 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1259 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1260
1261 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1262 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1263 used to start booting.
1264
1265 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1266 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1267 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1268 multiple audio codec chips).
1269 This interacts with software
1270 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1271 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1272 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1273 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1274 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1275 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1276 audio or video codecs are used.
1277
1278 @end itemize
1279
1280 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1281 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1282 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1283 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1284 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1285 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1286 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1287 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1288 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1289 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1290
1291
1292 @node Config File Guidelines
1293 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1294
1295 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1296 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1297 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1298 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1299
1300 You should find the following directories under @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts},
1301 with files including the ones listed here.
1302 Use them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1303 @itemize @bullet
1304 @item @file{interface} ...
1305 These are for debug adapters.
1306 Files that configure JTAG adapters go here.
1307 @example
1308 $ ls interface -R
1309 interface/:
1310 altera-usb-blaster.cfg hilscher_nxhx50_re.cfg openocd-usb-hs.cfg
1311 arm-jtag-ew.cfg hitex_str9-comstick.cfg openrd.cfg
1312 at91rm9200.cfg icebear.cfg osbdm.cfg
1313 axm0432.cfg jlink.cfg parport.cfg
1314 busblaster.cfg jtagkey2.cfg parport_dlc5.cfg
1315 buspirate.cfg jtagkey2p.cfg redbee-econotag.cfg
1316 calao-usb-a9260-c01.cfg jtagkey.cfg redbee-usb.cfg
1317 calao-usb-a9260-c02.cfg jtagkey-tiny.cfg rlink.cfg
1318 calao-usb-a9260.cfg jtag-lock-pick_tiny_2.cfg sheevaplug.cfg
1319 chameleon.cfg kt-link.cfg signalyzer.cfg
1320 cortino.cfg lisa-l.cfg signalyzer-h2.cfg
1321 digilent-hs1.cfg luminary.cfg signalyzer-h4.cfg
1322 dlp-usb1232h.cfg luminary-icdi.cfg signalyzer-lite.cfg
1323 dummy.cfg luminary-lm3s811.cfg stlink-v1.cfg
1324 estick.cfg minimodule.cfg stlink-v2.cfg
1325 flashlink.cfg neodb.cfg stm32-stick.cfg
1326 flossjtag.cfg ngxtech.cfg sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg
1327 flossjtag-noeeprom.cfg olimex-arm-usb-ocd.cfg ti-icdi.cfg
1328 flyswatter2.cfg olimex-arm-usb-ocd-h.cfg turtelizer2.cfg
1329 flyswatter.cfg olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg ulink.cfg
1330 ftdi olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg usb-jtag.cfg
1331 hilscher_nxhx10_etm.cfg oocdlink.cfg usbprog.cfg
1332 hilscher_nxhx500_etm.cfg opendous.cfg vpaclink.cfg
1333 hilscher_nxhx500_re.cfg opendous_ftdi.cfg vsllink.cfg
1334 hilscher_nxhx50_etm.cfg openocd-usb.cfg xds100v2.cfg
1335
1336 interface/ftdi:
1337 axm0432.cfg hitex_str9-comstick.cfg olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg
1338 calao-usb-a9260-c01.cfg icebear.cfg oocdlink.cfg
1339 calao-usb-a9260-c02.cfg jtagkey2.cfg opendous_ftdi.cfg
1340 cortino.cfg jtagkey2p.cfg openocd-usb.cfg
1341 dlp-usb1232h.cfg jtagkey.cfg openocd-usb-hs.cfg
1342 dp_busblaster.cfg jtag-lock-pick_tiny_2.cfg openrd.cfg
1343 flossjtag.cfg kt-link.cfg redbee-econotag.cfg
1344 flossjtag-noeeprom.cfg lisa-l.cfg redbee-usb.cfg
1345 flyswatter2.cfg luminary.cfg sheevaplug.cfg
1346 flyswatter.cfg luminary-icdi.cfg signalyzer.cfg
1347 gw16042.cfg luminary-lm3s811.cfg signalyzer-lite.cfg
1348 hilscher_nxhx10_etm.cfg minimodule.cfg stm32-stick.cfg
1349 hilscher_nxhx500_etm.cfg neodb.cfg turtelizer2-revB.cfg
1350 hilscher_nxhx500_re.cfg ngxtech.cfg turtelizer2-revC.cfg
1351 hilscher_nxhx50_etm.cfg olimex-arm-usb-ocd.cfg vpaclink.cfg
1352 hilscher_nxhx50_re.cfg olimex-arm-usb-ocd-h.cfg xds100v2.cfg
1353 hitex_lpc1768stick.cfg olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg
1354 $
1355 @end example
1356 @item @file{board} ...
1357 think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1358 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1359 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1360 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1361 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1362 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1363 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1364 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1365 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1366 a CPU and an FPGA.
1367 @example
1368 $ ls board
1369 actux3.cfg lpc1850_spifi_generic.cfg
1370 am3517evm.cfg lpc4350_spifi_generic.cfg
1371 arm_evaluator7t.cfg lubbock.cfg
1372 at91cap7a-stk-sdram.cfg mcb1700.cfg
1373 at91eb40a.cfg microchip_explorer16.cfg
1374 at91rm9200-dk.cfg mini2440.cfg
1375 at91rm9200-ek.cfg mini6410.cfg
1376 at91sam9261-ek.cfg netgear-dg834v3.cfg
1377 at91sam9263-ek.cfg olimex_LPC2378STK.cfg
1378 at91sam9g20-ek.cfg olimex_lpc_h2148.cfg
1379 atmel_at91sam7s-ek.cfg olimex_sam7_ex256.cfg
1380 atmel_at91sam9260-ek.cfg olimex_sam9_l9260.cfg
1381 atmel_at91sam9rl-ek.cfg olimex_stm32_h103.cfg
1382 atmel_sam3n_ek.cfg olimex_stm32_h107.cfg
1383 atmel_sam3s_ek.cfg olimex_stm32_p107.cfg
1384 atmel_sam3u_ek.cfg omap2420_h4.cfg
1385 atmel_sam3x_ek.cfg open-bldc.cfg
1386 atmel_sam4s_ek.cfg openrd.cfg
1387 balloon3-cpu.cfg osk5912.cfg
1388 colibri.cfg phone_se_j100i.cfg
1389 crossbow_tech_imote2.cfg phytec_lpc3250.cfg
1390 csb337.cfg pic-p32mx.cfg
1391 csb732.cfg propox_mmnet1001.cfg
1392 da850evm.cfg pxa255_sst.cfg
1393 digi_connectcore_wi-9c.cfg redbee.cfg
1394 diolan_lpc4350-db1.cfg rsc-w910.cfg
1395 dm355evm.cfg sheevaplug.cfg
1396 dm365evm.cfg smdk6410.cfg
1397 dm6446evm.cfg spear300evb.cfg
1398 efikamx.cfg spear300evb_mod.cfg
1399 eir.cfg spear310evb20.cfg
1400 ek-lm3s1968.cfg spear310evb20_mod.cfg
1401 ek-lm3s3748.cfg spear320cpu.cfg
1402 ek-lm3s6965.cfg spear320cpu_mod.cfg
1403 ek-lm3s811.cfg steval_pcc010.cfg
1404 ek-lm3s811-revb.cfg stm320518_eval_stlink.cfg
1405 ek-lm3s8962.cfg stm32100b_eval.cfg
1406 ek-lm3s9b9x.cfg stm3210b_eval.cfg
1407 ek-lm3s9d92.cfg stm3210c_eval.cfg
1408 ek-lm4f120xl.cfg stm3210e_eval.cfg
1409 ek-lm4f232.cfg stm3220g_eval.cfg
1410 embedded-artists_lpc2478-32.cfg stm3220g_eval_stlink.cfg
1411 ethernut3.cfg stm3241g_eval.cfg
1412 glyn_tonga2.cfg stm3241g_eval_stlink.cfg
1413 hammer.cfg stm32f0discovery.cfg
1414 hilscher_nxdb500sys.cfg stm32f3discovery.cfg
1415 hilscher_nxeb500hmi.cfg stm32f4discovery.cfg
1416 hilscher_nxhx10.cfg stm32ldiscovery.cfg
1417 hilscher_nxhx500.cfg stm32vldiscovery.cfg
1418 hilscher_nxhx50.cfg str910-eval.cfg
1419 hilscher_nxsb100.cfg telo.cfg
1420 hitex_lpc1768stick.cfg ti_am335xevm.cfg
1421 hitex_lpc2929.cfg ti_beagleboard.cfg
1422 hitex_stm32-performancestick.cfg ti_beagleboard_xm.cfg
1423 hitex_str9-comstick.cfg ti_beaglebone.cfg
1424 iar_lpc1768.cfg ti_blaze.cfg
1425 iar_str912_sk.cfg ti_pandaboard.cfg
1426 icnova_imx53_sodimm.cfg ti_pandaboard_es.cfg
1427 icnova_sam9g45_sodimm.cfg topas910.cfg
1428 imx27ads.cfg topasa900.cfg
1429 imx27lnst.cfg twr-k60f120m.cfg
1430 imx28evk.cfg twr-k60n512.cfg
1431 imx31pdk.cfg tx25_stk5.cfg
1432 imx35pdk.cfg tx27_stk5.cfg
1433 imx53loco.cfg unknown_at91sam9260.cfg
1434 keil_mcb1700.cfg uptech_2410.cfg
1435 keil_mcb2140.cfg verdex.cfg
1436 kwikstik.cfg voipac.cfg
1437 linksys_nslu2.cfg voltcraft_dso-3062c.cfg
1438 lisa-l.cfg x300t.cfg
1439 logicpd_imx27.cfg zy1000.cfg
1440 $
1441 @end example
1442 @item @file{target} ...
1443 think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1444 on a chip
1445 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1446 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1447 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1448 the target config file defines all of them.
1449 @example
1450 $ ls target
1451 aduc702x.cfg lpc1763.cfg
1452 am335x.cfg lpc1764.cfg
1453 amdm37x.cfg lpc1765.cfg
1454 ar71xx.cfg lpc1766.cfg
1455 at32ap7000.cfg lpc1767.cfg
1456 at91r40008.cfg lpc1768.cfg
1457 at91rm9200.cfg lpc1769.cfg
1458 at91sam3ax_4x.cfg lpc1788.cfg
1459 at91sam3ax_8x.cfg lpc17xx.cfg
1460 at91sam3ax_xx.cfg lpc1850.cfg
1461 at91sam3nXX.cfg lpc2103.cfg
1462 at91sam3sXX.cfg lpc2124.cfg
1463 at91sam3u1c.cfg lpc2129.cfg
1464 at91sam3u1e.cfg lpc2148.cfg
1465 at91sam3u2c.cfg lpc2294.cfg
1466 at91sam3u2e.cfg lpc2378.cfg
1467 at91sam3u4c.cfg lpc2460.cfg
1468 at91sam3u4e.cfg lpc2478.cfg
1469 at91sam3uxx.cfg lpc2900.cfg
1470 at91sam3XXX.cfg lpc2xxx.cfg
1471 at91sam4sd32x.cfg lpc3131.cfg
1472 at91sam4sXX.cfg lpc3250.cfg
1473 at91sam4XXX.cfg lpc4350.cfg
1474 at91sam7se512.cfg lpc4350.cfg.orig
1475 at91sam7sx.cfg mc13224v.cfg
1476 at91sam7x256.cfg nuc910.cfg
1477 at91sam7x512.cfg omap2420.cfg
1478 at91sam9260.cfg omap3530.cfg
1479 at91sam9260_ext_RAM_ext_flash.cfg omap4430.cfg
1480 at91sam9261.cfg omap4460.cfg
1481 at91sam9263.cfg omap5912.cfg
1482 at91sam9.cfg omapl138.cfg
1483 at91sam9g10.cfg pic32mx.cfg
1484 at91sam9g20.cfg pxa255.cfg
1485 at91sam9g45.cfg pxa270.cfg
1486 at91sam9rl.cfg pxa3xx.cfg
1487 atmega128.cfg readme.txt
1488 avr32.cfg samsung_s3c2410.cfg
1489 c100.cfg samsung_s3c2440.cfg
1490 c100config.tcl samsung_s3c2450.cfg
1491 c100helper.tcl samsung_s3c4510.cfg
1492 c100regs.tcl samsung_s3c6410.cfg
1493 cs351x.cfg sharp_lh79532.cfg
1494 davinci.cfg smp8634.cfg
1495 dragonite.cfg spear3xx.cfg
1496 dsp56321.cfg stellaris.cfg
1497 dsp568013.cfg stellaris_icdi.cfg
1498 dsp568037.cfg stm32f0x_stlink.cfg
1499 efm32_stlink.cfg stm32f1x.cfg
1500 epc9301.cfg stm32f1x_stlink.cfg
1501 faux.cfg stm32f2x.cfg
1502 feroceon.cfg stm32f2x_stlink.cfg
1503 fm3.cfg stm32f3x.cfg
1504 hilscher_netx10.cfg stm32f3x_stlink.cfg
1505 hilscher_netx500.cfg stm32f4x.cfg
1506 hilscher_netx50.cfg stm32f4x_stlink.cfg
1507 icepick.cfg stm32l.cfg
1508 imx21.cfg stm32lx_dual_bank.cfg
1509 imx25.cfg stm32lx_stlink.cfg
1510 imx27.cfg stm32_stlink.cfg
1511 imx28.cfg stm32w108_stlink.cfg
1512 imx31.cfg stm32xl.cfg
1513 imx35.cfg str710.cfg
1514 imx51.cfg str730.cfg
1515 imx53.cfg str750.cfg
1516 imx6.cfg str912.cfg
1517 imx.cfg swj-dp.tcl
1518 is5114.cfg test_reset_syntax_error.cfg
1519 ixp42x.cfg test_syntax_error.cfg
1520 k40.cfg ti-ar7.cfg
1521 k60.cfg ti_calypso.cfg
1522 lpc1751.cfg ti_dm355.cfg
1523 lpc1752.cfg ti_dm365.cfg
1524 lpc1754.cfg ti_dm6446.cfg
1525 lpc1756.cfg tmpa900.cfg
1526 lpc1758.cfg tmpa910.cfg
1527 lpc1759.cfg u8500.cfg
1528 @end example
1529 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1530 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1531 @end itemize
1532
1533 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1534 file may override features in any of the above files by
1535 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1536 commands specific to their situation.
1537
1538 @section Interface Config Files
1539
1540 The user config file
1541 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1542
1543 @example
1544 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1545 @end example
1546
1547 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1548 in use today with OpenOCD.
1549 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1550 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1551
1552 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1553 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1554 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1555 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1556 and need to provide a driver for it.
1557
1558 @section Board Config Files
1559 @cindex config file, board
1560 @cindex board config file
1561
1562 The user config file
1563 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1564
1565 @example
1566 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1567 @end example
1568
1569 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1570 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1571 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1572
1573 @enumerate
1574 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1575 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1576 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1577 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1578 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1579 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1580 @end enumerate
1581
1582 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1583 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1584 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1585 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1586
1587 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1588 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1589 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1590 configuration works.
1591
1592 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1593
1594 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1595 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1596 convention on how to use certain variables.
1597
1598 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1599 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1600 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1601 used at will within a target configuration file.
1602
1603 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1604 for a board with three chips:
1605
1606 @example
1607 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1608 set CHIPNAME network
1609 set ENDIAN big
1610 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1611 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1612 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1614
1615 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1616 set CHIPNAME video
1617 set ENDIAN little
1618 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1619 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1620 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1621 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1622
1623 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1624 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1625 unset ENDIAN
1626 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1627 @end example
1628
1629 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1630 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1631 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1632 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1633 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1634 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1635 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1636 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1637
1638 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1639 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1640 naming collisions.
1641
1642 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1643 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1644 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1645 up other clocks and peripherals.
1646
1647 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1648 @cindex variable names
1649
1650 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1651 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1652 one such chip (as shown above).
1653 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1654 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1655 to promote consistency and
1656 so that board files can override target defaults.
1657
1658 Inputs to target config files include:
1659
1660 @itemize @bullet
1661 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1662 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1663 tap identifier dotted names.
1664 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1665 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1666 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1667 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1668 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1669 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1670 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1671 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1672 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1673 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1674 @end itemize
1675
1676 Outputs from target config files include:
1677
1678 @itemize @bullet
1679 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1680 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1681 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1682 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1683 specific to that board and that target.
1684 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1685 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1686 @end itemize
1687
1688 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1689 @cindex event, reset-init
1690 @cindex reset-init handler
1691
1692 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1693 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1694 fully set up yet.
1695 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1696 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1697 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1698 handler is one of the most important.
1699
1700 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1701 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1702 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1703 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1704 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1705
1706 @quotation Note
1707 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1708 are included here.
1709 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1710 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1711 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1712 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1713 @end quotation
1714
1715 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1716 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1717 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1718 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1719 those as parameters.
1720 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1721 and disabling the watchdog.
1722 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1723 the next developer doing such work.
1724 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1725
1726 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1727 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1728 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1729 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1730
1731 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1732
1733 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1734 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1735 a low JTAG clock rate.
1736 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1737 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1738 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1739 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1740 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1741 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1742 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1743
1744 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1745 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1746 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1747 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1748 which might be less than that.
1749
1750 @quotation Warning
1751 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1752 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1753 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1754 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1755 @end quotation
1756
1757 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1758 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1759 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1760 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1761 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1762 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1763
1764 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1765 @subsection The init_board procedure
1766 @cindex init_board procedure
1767
1768 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1769 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1770 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1771 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1772 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1773 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1774 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1775 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1776 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1777 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1778 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1779 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1780
1781 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1782 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1783
1784 @example
1785 ### board_file.cfg ###
1786
1787 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1788 source [find target/target.cfg]
1789
1790 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1791 # enables fast on-board clock source
1792 # configures the chip to use it
1793 @}
1794
1795 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1796 proc init_board @{@} @{
1797 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1798
1799 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1800 adapter_khz 1
1801 enable_fast_clock
1802 adapter_khz 10000
1803 @}
1804 @}
1805 @end example
1806
1807 @section Target Config Files
1808 @cindex config file, target
1809 @cindex target config file
1810
1811 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1812 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1813 more target config files like this:
1814
1815 @example
1816 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1817 @end example
1818
1819 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1820 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1821 In summary the target files should contain
1822
1823 @enumerate
1824 @item Set defaults
1825 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1826 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1827 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1828 @item On-Chip flash
1829 @end enumerate
1830
1831 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1832 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1833 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1834
1835 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1836 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1837 can talk to the chip.
1838 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1839 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1840 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1841 and other processing engines.
1842
1843 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1844
1845 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1846 letting board config files express environment-specific
1847 differences in how things should be set up.
1848
1849 @example
1850 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1851 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1852 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1853 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1854 @} else @{
1855 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1856 @}
1857
1858 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1859 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1860 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1861 @} else @{
1862 set _ENDIAN little
1863 @}
1864
1865 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1866 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1867 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1868 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1869 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1870 @} else @{
1871 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1872 @}
1873 @end example
1874 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1875
1876 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1877 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1878 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1879
1880 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1881 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1882 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1883
1884 @example
1885 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1886 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1887 @end example
1888
1889 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1890 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1891 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1892 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1893 for taps.
1894
1895 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1896 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1897 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1898 looks (in part) like this:
1899
1900 @example
1901 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1902 @end example
1903
1904 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1905 to source such a config file twice, with different
1906 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1907 it adds a different TAP each time.
1908
1909 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1910 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1911 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1912 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1913
1914 @example
1915 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1916 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1917 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1918 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1919 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1920 @end example
1921
1922 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1923 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1924
1925 @itemize
1926 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1927 plus a JRC to enable them
1928 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1929 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1930 is not currently used)
1931 @end itemize
1932
1933 @subsection Add CPU targets
1934
1935 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1936 GDB and other commands can use it.
1937 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1938 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1939 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1940 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1941
1942 @example
1943 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1944 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1945 @end example
1946
1947 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1948 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1949 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1950 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1951 a work area if you can.
1952 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1953
1954 @example
1955 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1956 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1957 @end example
1958
1959 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1960 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1961 @cindex SMP
1962 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1963
1964 @example
1965 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1966 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1967 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1968 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1969 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1970 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1971 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1972 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1973 @end example
1974 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1975 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1976 @itemize @bullet
1977 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1978 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1979 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1980 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1981 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1982 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1983 @end itemize
1984
1985 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1986 command have been implemented.
1987 @itemize @bullet
1988 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1989 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1990 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1991 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1992 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1993 following example.
1994 @end itemize
1995
1996 @example
1997 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1998 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1999 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
2000 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
2001 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
2002 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
2003 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
2004 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
2005 > resume
2006 > cortex_a smp_gdb
2007 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
2008 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
2009 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
2010 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
2011 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
2012 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
2013 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
2014 @end example
2015
2016
2017 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
2018
2019 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
2020 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
2021 chip can be tweaked by the board.
2022
2023 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
2024 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
2025 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
2026 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
2027 both signals.
2028
2029 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
2030 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
2031 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
2032 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
2033 don't want to reset all targets at once.
2034 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
2035 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
2036 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
2037 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
2038 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
2039 not available.)
2040
2041 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
2042 they're going to be used with JTAG.
2043 An example might be needing to send some commands right
2044 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
2045 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
2046 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
2047 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
2048 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
2049
2050 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
2051 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
2052 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
2053 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
2054 slower clock than they will use later.
2055 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
2056 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
2057 than they will use later.
2058 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
2059
2060 @quotation Important
2061 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
2062 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
2063 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
2064 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
2065 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
2066 @end quotation
2067
2068 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
2069 @subsection The init_targets procedure
2070 @cindex init_targets procedure
2071
2072 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
2073 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
2074 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
2075 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
2076 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
2077 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
2078 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
2079 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
2080 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
2081
2082 @example
2083 ### generic_file.cfg ###
2084
2085 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
2086 # basic initialization procedure ...
2087 @}
2088
2089 proc init_targets @{@} @{
2090 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
2091 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
2092 @}
2093
2094 ### specific_file.cfg ###
2095
2096 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
2097
2098 proc init_targets @{@} @{
2099 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
2100 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
2101 @}
2102 @end example
2103
2104 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
2105 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
2106
2107 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
2108
2109 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
2110 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
2111
2112 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
2113 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
2114 @cindex init_target_events procedure
2115
2116 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
2117 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
2118 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
2119 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
2120 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
2121 events already assigned.
2122
2123 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
2124
2125 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
2126 special high speed download features - enable it.
2127
2128 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
2129
2130 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
2131 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
2132 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
2133 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
2134 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
2135 If you are using an external trace port,
2136 configure it in your board config file.
2137 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
2138 configure it in your target config file.
2139
2140 @example
2141 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
2142 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
2143 @end example
2144
2145 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
2146
2147 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
2148
2149 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
2150 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
2151 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
2152 the TARGET (chip) file.
2153
2154 Examples:
2155 @itemize @bullet
2156 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
2157 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
2158 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
2159 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
2160 @end itemize
2161
2162 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
2163 @section Translating Configuration Files
2164 @cindex translation
2165 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2166 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2167 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2168 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2169 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2170 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2171
2172 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2173 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2174 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2175 convert other scripts later on.
2176
2177 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2178 replace job:
2179
2180 @example
2181 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2182 #
2183 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2184 #
2185 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2186 #
2187 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2188
2189 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2190 global TARGETNAME
2191
2192 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2193
2194 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2195 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2196 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2197 @}
2198 @end example
2199
2200
2201
2202 @node Daemon Configuration
2203 @chapter Daemon Configuration
2204 @cindex initialization
2205 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2206 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2207 supported.
2208
2209 @anchor{configurationstage}
2210 @section Configuration Stage
2211 @cindex configuration stage
2212 @cindex config command
2213
2214 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2215 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2216 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2217 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2218 inside startup scripts.
2219
2220 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2221 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2222 which may be issued interactively.
2223 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2224 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2225
2226 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2227 flash banks,
2228 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2229 and other basic setup.
2230 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2231 may access or activate TAPs.
2232 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2233 longer be issued.
2234
2235 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2236 @section Entering the Run Stage
2237
2238 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2239 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2240 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2241 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2242 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2243 You should see no errors at this point.
2244 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2245 commands you used to configure the server.
2246 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2247 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2248 on the scan chain.
2249
2250 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2251 become available.
2252 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2253 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2254 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2255 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2256 entry to the run stage.
2257
2258 @deffn {Config Command} init
2259 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2260 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2261 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2262 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2263 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2264 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2265
2266 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2267 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2268 configuration files and/or command line options.
2269
2270 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2271 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2272 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2273 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2274 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2275 @end deffn
2276
2277 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2278 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2279 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2280
2281 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2282 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2283 scan chain.
2284 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2285 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2286
2287 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2288 they return.
2289 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2290 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2291 @end deffn
2292
2293 @anchor{tcpipports}
2294 @section TCP/IP Ports
2295 @cindex TCP port
2296 @cindex server
2297 @cindex port
2298 @cindex security
2299 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2300 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2301 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2302
2303 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2304 access using one or more of these ports.
2305 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2306 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2307 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2308
2309 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2310 @cindex GDB server
2311 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2312 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2313 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2314 the normal use cases.
2315
2316 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2317 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2318 disables the gdb server.
2319
2320 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2321 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2322
2323 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2324 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2325
2326 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2327 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2328 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2329
2330 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2331 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2332 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2333 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2334 @end deffn
2335
2336 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2337 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2338 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2339 output from the Tcl engine.
2340 Intended as a machine interface.
2341 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2342 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2343
2344 @end deffn
2345
2346 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2347 Specify or query the
2348 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2349 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2350 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2351 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2352 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2353 @end deffn
2354
2355 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2356 @section GDB Configuration
2357 @cindex GDB
2358 @cindex GDB configuration
2359 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2360 The ones listed here are static and global.
2361 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2362 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2363
2364 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2365 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2366 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2367 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2368 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2369 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2370 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2371 @end deffn
2372
2373 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2374 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2375 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2376 vFlash packet is received.
2377 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2378 @end deffn
2379
2380 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2381 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2382 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2383 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2384 for flash programming to work.
2385 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2386 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2387 @end deffn
2388
2389 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2390 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2391 by GDB memory read packets.
2392 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2393 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2394 @end deffn
2395
2396 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2397 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2398 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2402 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2403
2404 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2405 @end deffn
2406
2407 @anchor{eventpolling}
2408 @section Event Polling
2409
2410 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2411 where significant events can happen at any time.
2412 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2413 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2414 or to GDB.
2415
2416 Examples of such events include:
2417
2418 @itemize
2419 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2420 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2421 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2422 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2423 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2424 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2425 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2426 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2427 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2428 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2429 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2430 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2431 @end itemize
2432
2433 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2434 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2435 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2436 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2437 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2438
2439 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2440 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2441 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2442 to the various active targets.
2443 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2444 which is normally done in the background.
2445
2446 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2447 Poll the current target for its current state.
2448 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2449 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2450 specific information about the current state is printed.
2451 An optional parameter
2452 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2453
2454 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2455 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2456 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2457 @example
2458 > poll
2459 background polling: on
2460 target state: halted
2461 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2462 current mode: Supervisor
2463 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2464 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2465 >
2466 @end example
2467 @end deffn
2468
2469 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2470 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2471 @cindex config file, interface
2472 @cindex interface config file
2473
2474 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2475 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2476 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2477
2478 @quotation Note
2479 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2480 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2481 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2482 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2483 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2484 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2485 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2486 @end quotation
2487
2488 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2489 through commands in an interface configuration
2490 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2491 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2492
2493 @example
2494 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2495 @end example
2496
2497 These commands tell
2498 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2499 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2500
2501 @example
2502 # jlink interface
2503 interface jlink
2504 @end example
2505
2506 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2507
2508
2509 @section Interface Configuration
2510
2511 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2512 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2513 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2516 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2517 target.
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2521 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2522 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2523 @end deffn
2524 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2525 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2526 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2527 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2528 the hardware can support.
2529 @end deffn
2530
2531
2532
2533 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2534 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2535 @end deffn
2536
2537 @section Interface Drivers
2538
2539 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2540 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2541 available at run time.
2542
2543 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2544 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2545 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2546 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2547
2548 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2549 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2550 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2551 @end deffn
2552
2553 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2554 Displays status of RTCK option.
2555 Optionally sets that option first.
2556 @end deffn
2557 @end deffn
2558
2559 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2560 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2561 This has one driver-specific command:
2562
2563 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2564 Logs some status
2565 @end deffn
2566 @end deffn
2567
2568 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2569 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2570 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2571 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2572 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2573 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2577 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2578
2579 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2580 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2581 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2582 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2583 @example
2584 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2585 @end example
2586 @end deffn
2587
2588 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2589 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2590 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2591 @end deffn
2592
2593 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2594 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2595 @end deffn
2596 @end deffn
2597
2598 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2599 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2600 @end deffn
2601
2602 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2603 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2604 @end deffn
2605
2606 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2607 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2608
2609 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2610 recommended as its replacement.
2611
2612 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2613 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2614
2615 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2616 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2617 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2618 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2619 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2620 @end deffn
2621
2622 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2623 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2624 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2625 is connected to the host.
2626 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2627 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2628 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2629 @end deffn
2630
2631 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2632 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2633 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2634 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2635 @itemize @minus
2636 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2637 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2638 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2639 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2640 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2641 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2642 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2643 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2644 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2645 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2646 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2647 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2648 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2649 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2650 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2651 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2652 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2653 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2654 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2655 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2656 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2657 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2658 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2659 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2660 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2661 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2662 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2663 @end itemize
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2667 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2668 default values are used.
2669 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2670 @example
2671 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2672 @end example
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2676 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2677 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2678 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2679 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2680 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2681 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2685 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2686 The default value is 1.
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 For example, the interface config file for a
2690 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2691
2692 @example
2693 interface ft2232
2694 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2695 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2696 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2697 @end example
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2701 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2702 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2703 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2704 interface driver.
2705
2706 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2707 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2708 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2709
2710 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2711 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2712 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2713
2714 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2715 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2716 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2717 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2718 will be used for their customary purpose.
2719
2720 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2721 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2722 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2723 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2724
2725 @itemize @minus
2726 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2727 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2728 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2729 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2730 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2731 switching data and direction as necessary
2732 @end itemize
2733
2734 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2735 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2736
2737 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2738 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2739 default values are used.
2740 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2741 @example
2742 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2743 @end example
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2747 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2748 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2749 during device selection.
2750 @end deffn
2751
2752 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2753 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2754 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2755 is connected to the host.
2756 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2757 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2758 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2759 @end deffn
2760
2761 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2762 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2763 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2764 @end deffn
2765
2766 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2767 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2768 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2769 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2770 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2771 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2772 and initially asserted reset signals.
2773 @end deffn
2774
2775 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2776 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2777 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2778 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2779 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2780 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2781 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2782 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2783 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2784
2785 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2786 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2787 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2788 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2789 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2790 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2791
2792 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2793 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2794 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2795 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2796 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2797 are always driven by the FTDI.
2798
2799 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2800 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2801 @var{name}.
2802 @end deffn
2803
2804 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2805 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2806 @itemize @minus
2807 @item @option{0}, drive low
2808 @item @option{1}, drive high
2809 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2810 @end itemize
2811 @end deffn
2812
2813 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2814 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2815 @end deffn
2816
2817 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2818 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2819 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2820 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2821
2822 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2823 processors which are being simulated.
2824
2825 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2826 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2827 sockets instead of TCP.
2828 @end deffn
2829
2830 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2831 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2832 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2833 @end deffn
2834
2835 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2836 something like:
2837
2838 @example
2839 interface remote_bitbang
2840 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2841 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2842 @end example
2843
2844 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2845 named mysocket:
2846
2847 @example
2848 interface remote_bitbang
2849 remote_bitbang_port 0
2850 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2851 @end example
2852 @end deffn
2853
2854 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2855 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2856 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2857 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2858
2859 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2860 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2861 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2862 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2863 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2864 @end deffn
2865
2866 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2867 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2868 default values are used.
2869 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2870 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2871 @example
2872 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2873 @end example
2874 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2875 @example
2876 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2877 @end example
2878 @end deffn
2879
2880 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1})
2881 Sets the state of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters (pins 6 and 8 on the
2882 female JTAG header). These pins can be used as SRST and/or TRST provided the
2883 appropriate connections are made on the target board.
2884
2885 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST (as with an AVR board):
2886 @example
2887 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-assert \
2888 "usb_blaster pin6 1; wait 1; usb_blaster pin6 0"
2889 @end example
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @end deffn
2893
2894 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2895 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2896 This has one driver-specific command:
2897
2898 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2899 Display either the address of the I/O port
2900 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2901 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2902 This is a write-once setting.
2903 @end deffn
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2907 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2908
2909 @quotation Compatibility Note
2910 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2911 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2912 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2913 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2914 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2915 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2916 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2917 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2918 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2919 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2920 @end quotation
2921
2922 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2923 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2924 @end deffn
2925 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2926 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2927 @end deffn
2928 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2929 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2930 @end deffn
2931 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2932 Display the J-Link configuration.
2933 @end deffn
2934 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2935 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2936 @end deffn
2937 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2938 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2939 @end deffn
2940 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2941 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2942 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2943 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2944 @end deffn
2945 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2946 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2947 @end deffn
2948 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2949 Reset the current configuration.
2950 @end deffn
2951 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2952 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2953 @end deffn
2954 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2955 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2956 @end deffn
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2960 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2961 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2962 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2963 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2964
2965 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2966 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2967 This is a write-once setting.
2968 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2969
2970 @itemize @minus
2971 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2972 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2973 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2974 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2975 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2976 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2977 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2978 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2979 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2980 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2981 some versions of
2982 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2983 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2984 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2985 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2986 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2987 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2988 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2989 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2990 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2991 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2992 @end itemize
2993 @end deffn
2994
2995 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2996 Display either the address of the I/O port
2997 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2998 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2999 This is a write-once setting.
3000
3001 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3002 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3003 you may encounter a problem.
3004 @end deffn
3005
3006 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3007 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3008 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3009 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
3010 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3011 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3012
3013 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3014 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3015 @quotation Tip
3016 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3017 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3018 @example
3019 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3020 > adapter_khz 500
3021 @end example
3022 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3023 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3024 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3025 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3026 large set of samples.
3027 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3028 @example
3029 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3030 @end example
3031 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3032 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3033
3034 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3035 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3036 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3037 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3038 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3039 @end quotation
3040 @end deffn
3041
3042 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3043 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3044 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3045 @end deffn
3046
3047 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3048 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3049
3050 @example
3051 interface parport
3052 parport_port 0x278
3053 parport_cable wiggler
3054 @end example
3055 @end deffn
3056
3057 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3058 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3059 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3060 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3061 @end deffn
3062 @end deffn
3063
3064 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3065 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3066 @end deffn
3067
3068 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3069 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3070 @end deffn
3071
3072 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3073 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3074
3075 @quotation Note
3076 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3077 which are not currently documented here.
3078 @end quotation
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3082 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3083 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3084 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3085
3086 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
3087 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3088 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3089 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
3090 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3091
3092 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3093 Currently Not Supported.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3097 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3101 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3102 @end deffn
3103
3104 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
3105 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
3106 @end deffn
3107
3108 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3109 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3110 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {trace} source_clock_hz [output_file_path]
3114 Enable SWO tracing (if supported). The source clock rate for the
3115 trace port must be specified, this is typically the CPU clock rate. If
3116 the optional output file is specified then raw trace data is appended
3117 to the file, and the file is created if it does not exist.
3118 @end deffn
3119 @end deffn
3120
3121 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3122 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3123 @end deffn
3124
3125 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3126 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3130 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3131 @end deffn
3132
3133 @quotation Note
3134 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3135 which are not currently documented here.
3136 @end quotation
3137
3138 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3139 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3140 No arguments: print status.
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3144 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3145 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3146
3147 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3148 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3149 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3150 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3151 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3152 configuration on exit.
3153
3154 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3155 pinout.
3156
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 @section Transport Configuration
3160 @cindex Transport
3161 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3162 and the debug adapter you are using,
3163 several transports may be available to
3164 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3165 @deffn Command {transport list}
3166 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3167 version of OpenOCD.
3168 @end deffn
3169
3170 @deffn Command {transport select} transport_name
3171 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3172 The transport must be supported by the debug adapter hardware and by the
3173 version of OpenOCD you are using (including the adapter's driver).
3174 No arguments: returns name of session's selected transport.
3175 @end deffn
3176
3177 @subsection JTAG Transport
3178 @cindex JTAG
3179 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3180 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3181 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3182 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3183 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3184 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3185 @subsection SWD Transport
3186 @cindex SWD
3187 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3188 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3189 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3190 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3191 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3192 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3193 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3194 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3195 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3196 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3197 expected to change.
3198 @end deffn
3199 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3200 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3201 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3202 No parameters: displays current settings.
3203 @end deffn
3204
3205 @subsection CMSIS-DAP Transport
3206 @cindex CMSIS-DAP
3207 CMSIS-DAP is an ARM-specific transport that is used to connect to
3208 compilant debuggers.
3209
3210 @subsection SPI Transport
3211 @cindex SPI
3212 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3213 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3214 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3215 solution for flash programming.
3216
3217 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3218 @section JTAG Speed
3219 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3220 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3221 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3222 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3223 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3224 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3225 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3226 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3227 power management software that may be active.
3228
3229 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3230 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3231 target event handler.
3232 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3233 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3234 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3235 sets up those clocks).
3236 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3237 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3238 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3239 in the target config file.
3240 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3241 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3242 config file instead.
3243 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3244 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3245 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3246
3247 @example
3248 jtag_rclk 3000
3249 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3250 @end example
3251
3252 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3253 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3254 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3255 may not be the fastest solution.
3256
3257 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3258 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3259 which support adaptive clocking.
3260
3261 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3262 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3263 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3264 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3265 than the speed specified.
3266
3267 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3268 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3269 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3270 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3271
3272 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3273 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3274 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3275 JTAG clocking after setup.
3276 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3277 If the interface device can not
3278 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3279 @end deffn
3280
3281 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3282 @cindex adaptive clocking
3283 @cindex RTCK
3284 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3285 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3286 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3287 @example
3288 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3289 jtag_rclk 3000
3290 @end example
3291 @end defun
3292
3293 @node Reset Configuration
3294 @chapter Reset Configuration
3295 @cindex Reset Configuration
3296
3297 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3298 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3299 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3300 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3301 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3302 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3303 Please see the various board files for examples.
3304
3305 @quotation Note
3306 To maintainers and integrators:
3307 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3308 Normally the board configuration file
3309 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3310 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3311
3312 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3313 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3314 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3315 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3316 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3317 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3318 @end quotation
3319
3320 @section Types of Reset
3321
3322 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3323 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3324 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3325
3326 @itemize @bullet
3327 @item
3328 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3329 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3330 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3331 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3332 @item
3333 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3334 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3335 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3336 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3337 @item
3338 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3339 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3340 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3341 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3342 @item
3343 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3344 several other types of reset.
3345 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3346 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3347 There may be individual module resets.
3348 @end itemize
3349
3350 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3351 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3352 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3353 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3354 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3355 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3356 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3357 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3358 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3359
3360 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3361 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3362
3363 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3364 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3365 common issues are:
3366
3367 @itemize @bullet
3368
3369 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3370 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3371 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3372 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3373 when either of those signals is not connected.
3374 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3375 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3376 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3377 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3378
3379 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3380 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3381 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3382 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3383
3384 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3385 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3386 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3387 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3388 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3389 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3390 hardware debouncing.
3391 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3392 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3393
3394 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3395 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3396 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3397 to use push/pull output drivers.
3398 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3399 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3400 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3401 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3402
3403 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3404 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3405 issues (not limited to errata).
3406 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3407 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3408 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3409 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3410 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3411 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3412 @end itemize
3413
3414 There can also be other issues.
3415 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3416 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3417 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3418 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3419 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3420 Agreement (NDA).
3421
3422 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3423 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3424 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3425
3426 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3427 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3428
3429 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3430
3431 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3432 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3433 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3434 allowing it to be deasserted.
3435 @end deffn
3436
3437 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3438 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3439 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3440 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3441 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3442 @end deffn
3443
3444 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3445 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3446 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3447 allowing it to be deasserted.
3448 @end deffn
3449
3450 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3451 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3452 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3453 @end deffn
3454
3455 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3456 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3457 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3458 configuration scripts.
3459
3460 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3461 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3462 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3463 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3464 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3465 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3466 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3467 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3468
3469 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3470 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3471 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3472 -- may be specified at a time.
3473 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3474 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3475 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3476 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3477 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3478
3479 @itemize
3480 @item
3481 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3482 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3483 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3484 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3485 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3486
3487 @quotation Tip
3488 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3489 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3490 @end quotation
3491
3492 @item
3493 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3494 signal implementations.
3495 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3496 indicating everything behaves normally.
3497 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3498 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3499 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3500 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3501 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3502 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3503 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3504
3505 @item
3506 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3507 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3508 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3509 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3510 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3511 while SRST is asserted.
3512 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3513 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3514
3515 @item
3516 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3517 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3518 is required to use this option.
3519 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3520 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3521 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3522 be asserted before any target connection.
3523 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3524 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3525 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3526 @end itemize
3527
3528 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3529 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3530 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3531 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3532 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3533
3534 @itemize
3535 @item
3536 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3537 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3538 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3539 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3540
3541 @item
3542 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3543 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3544 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3545 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3546 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3547 @end itemize
3548 @end deffn
3549
3550 @section Custom Reset Handling
3551 @cindex events
3552
3553 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3554 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3555 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3556 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3557 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3558 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3559
3560 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3561 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3562 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3563 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3564 want to reset everything at once.
3565
3566 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3567 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3568 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3569 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3570 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3571 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3572 needs special attention.
3573
3574 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3575 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3576 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3577 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3578 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3579 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3580 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3581 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3582
3583 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3584 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3585 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3586 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3587 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3588
3589 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3590 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3591 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3592 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3593 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3594 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3595 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3596 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3597 or potentially some other value.
3598
3599 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3600 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3601 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3602 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3603 (or their associated targets)
3604 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3605
3606 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3607 they return.
3608 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3609 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3610 @end deffn
3611
3612 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3613 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3614 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3615 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3616 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3617 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3618 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3619 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3620 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3621 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3622 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3623 @end deffn
3624
3625 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3626 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3627 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3628 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3629 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3630 @end deffn
3631
3632
3633 @node TAP Declaration
3634 @chapter TAP Declaration
3635 @cindex TAP declaration
3636 @cindex TAP configuration
3637
3638 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3639 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3640
3641 @itemize @bullet
3642 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3643 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3644 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3645 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3646 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3647 start running that code.
3648 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3649 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3650 and missing connections.
3651 @end itemize
3652
3653 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3654 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3655 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3656 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3657 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3658
3659 @section Scan Chains
3660 @cindex scan chain
3661
3662 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3663 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3664 They also need to be added to
3665 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3666 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3667 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3668 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3669 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3670 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3671 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3672 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3673
3674 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3675 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3676 command, presented in the next chapter.
3677 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3678 debugging targets.)
3679 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3680
3681 @verbatim
3682 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3683 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3684 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3685 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3686 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3687 @end verbatim
3688
3689 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3690 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3691 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3692 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3693 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3694 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3695 until they are told to do so.
3696
3697 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3698 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3699 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3700 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3701
3702 @example
3703 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3704 @end example
3705
3706 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3707 by a given chip.
3708 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3709 and so forth.
3710 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3711 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3712 both inside a single chip and between them.
3713 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3714
3715 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3716 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3717 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3718 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3719 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3720 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3721 includes commands something like this:
3722
3723 @example
3724 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3725 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3726 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3727 @end example
3728
3729 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3730 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3731 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3732
3733 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3734 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3735 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3736 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3737 @example
3738 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3739 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3740 @}
3741 @end example
3742 @end deffn
3743
3744 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3745 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3746 and their status.
3747 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3748 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3749 but systems with a JTAG router can
3750 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3751 @end deffn
3752
3753 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3754 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3755
3756 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3757 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3758
3759 @section TAP Names
3760 @cindex dotted name
3761
3762 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3763 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3764 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3765 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3766 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3767 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3768 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3769 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3770
3771 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3772 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3773 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3774
3775 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3776
3777 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3778 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3779 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3780 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3781
3782 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3783 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3784 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3785 overridable.
3786
3787 @cindex TAP naming convention
3788 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3789 and should follow this convention:
3790
3791 @itemize @bullet
3792 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3793 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3794 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3795 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3796 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3797 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3798 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3799 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3800 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3801 with a single TAP;
3802 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3803 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3804 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3805 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3806 @end itemize
3807
3808 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3809
3810 @itemize @bullet
3811 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3812 @*The length in bits of the
3813 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3814 @end itemize
3815
3816 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3817
3818 @itemize @bullet
3819 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3820 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3821 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3822 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3823 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3824 (the TAP is linked in).
3825 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3826 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3827 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3828 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3829 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3830 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3831 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3832 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3833 values that were found but not included in the list.
3834
3835 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3836 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3837 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3838 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3839 hardware to find these values.
3840 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3841 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3842 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3843 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3844 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3845 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3846 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3847 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3848 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3849 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3850 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3851 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3852 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3853 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3854 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3855 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3856 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3857 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3858 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3859 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3860 @end itemize
3861 @end deffn
3862
3863 @section Other TAP commands
3864
3865 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3866 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3867 At this writing this TAP attribute
3868 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3869 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3870 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3871 See the next section for information about the available events.
3872
3873 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3874 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3875 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3876 @end deffn
3877
3878 @section TAP Events
3879 @cindex events
3880 @cindex TAP events
3881
3882 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3883 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3884 The other applies to debugger targets,
3885 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3886
3887 The TAP events currently defined are:
3888
3889 @itemize @bullet
3890 @item @b{post-reset}
3891 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3892 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3893 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3894 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3895 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3896
3897 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3898 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3899 of any particular target.
3900 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3901 @item @b{setup}
3902 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3903 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3904 @item @b{tap-disable}
3905 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3906 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3907 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3908 @item @b{tap-enable}
3909 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3910 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3911 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3912 @end itemize
3913
3914 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3915 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3916 contents to be accurate), you might:
3917
3918 @example
3919 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3920 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3921 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3922 @}
3923 @end example
3924
3925
3926 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3927 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3928 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3929 @cindex jrc
3930
3931 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3932 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3933 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3934 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3935 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3936
3937 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3938 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3939 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3940 be visible.
3941 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3942 ignores, such as:
3943
3944 @itemize
3945 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3946 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3947 TAPs receive new instructions.
3948 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3949 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3950 @end itemize
3951
3952 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3953 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3954 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3955 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3956
3957 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3958 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3959
3960 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3961 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3962 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3963 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3964 should define TAP event handlers using
3965 code that looks something like this:
3966
3967 @example
3968 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3969 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3970 @}
3971 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3972 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3973 @}
3974 @end example
3975
3976 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3977
3978 @example
3979 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3980 @end example
3981
3982 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3983 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3984 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3985 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3986
3987 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3988 If necessary, disables the tap
3989 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3990 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3991 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3992 and "0" if it is disabled.
3993 @end deffn
3994
3995 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3996 If necessary, enables the tap
3997 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3998 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3999 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4000 and "0" if it is disabled.
4001 @end deffn
4002
4003 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4004 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4005 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4006 and "0" if it is disabled.
4007
4008 @quotation Note
4009 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4010 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4011 @end quotation
4012 @end deffn
4013
4014 @anchor{autoprobing}
4015 @section Autoprobing
4016 @cindex autoprobe
4017 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4018
4019 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4020 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4021 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4022 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4023
4024 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4025 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4026 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4027 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4028 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4029 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4030 right when they come out of reset).
4031
4032 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4033
4034 @example
4035 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4036 reset_config trst_and_srst
4037 jtag_rclk 8
4038 @end example
4039
4040 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4041 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4042
4043 @enumerate
4044 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4045 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4046 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4047 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4048 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4049 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4050 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4051 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4052 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4053 that is discovered.
4054 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4055 register, it will report it.
4056 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4057 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4058 @end enumerate
4059
4060 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4061 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4062 that's a bit more complex:
4063
4064 @example
4065 clock speed 8 kHz
4066 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4067 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4068 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4069 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4070 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4071 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4072 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4073 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4074 @end example
4075
4076 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4077 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4078 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4079 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4080 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4081 and so forth.
4082
4083 @node CPU Configuration
4084 @chapter CPU Configuration
4085 @cindex GDB target
4086
4087 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4088 You can also access these targets without GDB
4089 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4090 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4091 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4092 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4093
4094 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4095 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4096
4097 @section Target List
4098 @cindex target, current
4099 @cindex target, list
4100
4101 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4102 where each member has a name.
4103 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4104 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4105 (plural!) command.
4106 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4107 look like with more than one:
4108 @verbatim
4109 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4110 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4111 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4112 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4113 @end verbatim
4114
4115 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4116 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4117 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4118 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4119 space seen by that current target.
4120 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4121 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4122 are examples; and there are many more.
4123
4124 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4125
4126 @deffn Command {target count}
4127 @emph{Note: target numbers are deprecated; don't use them.
4128 They will be removed shortly after August 2010, including this command.
4129 Iterate target using @command{target names}, not by counting.}
4130
4131 Returns the number of targets, @math{N}.
4132 The highest numbered target is @math{N - 1}.
4133 @example
4134 set c [target count]
4135 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < $c @} @{ incr x @} @{
4136 # Assuming you have created this function
4137 print_target_details $x
4138 @}
4139 @end example
4140 @end deffn
4141
4142 @deffn Command {target current}
4143 Returns the name of the current target.
4144 @end deffn
4145
4146 @deffn Command {target names}
4147 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4148 @example
4149 foreach t [target names] @{
4150 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4151 @}
4152 @end example
4153 @end deffn
4154
4155 @deffn Command {target number} number
4156 @emph{Note: target numbers are deprecated; don't use them.
4157 They will be removed shortly after August 2010, including this command.}
4158
4159 The list of targets is numbered starting at zero.
4160 This command returns the name of the target at index @var{number}.
4161 @example
4162 set thename [target number $x]
4163 puts [format "Target %d is: %s\n" $x $thename]
4164 @end example
4165 @end deffn
4166
4167 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4168 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4169
4170 @deffn Command targets [name]
4171 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4172 command names are singular.}
4173
4174 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4175 targets in a user friendly form.
4176
4177 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4178 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4179 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4180 @end deffn
4181
4182 @section Target CPU Types
4183 @cindex target type
4184 @cindex CPU type
4185
4186 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4187 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4188 when calling @command{target create}.
4189 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4190 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4191 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4192 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4193 what core-specific commands may be available
4194 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4195 and more.
4196
4197 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4198 since there's a command to list them.
4199
4200 @anchor{targettypes}
4201 @deffn Command {target types}
4202 Lists all supported target types.
4203 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4204
4205 @itemize @bullet
4206 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4207 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4208 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4209 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4210 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4211 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4212 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4213 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4214 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4215 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4216 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4217 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4218 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4219 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4220 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4221 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4222 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4223 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4224 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4225 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4226 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4227 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4228 @itemize @minus
4229 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4230 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @emph{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4231 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @emph{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4232 @end itemize
4233 And two debug interfaces cores:
4234 @itemize @minus
4235 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4236 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4237 @end itemize
4238 @end itemize
4239 @end deffn
4240
4241 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4242 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4243 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4244 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4245 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4246 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4247 reflect design generations;
4248 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4249 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4250
4251 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4252 @section Target Configuration
4253
4254 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4255 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4256 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4257 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4258 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4259
4260 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4261 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4262 optional parts.
4263 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4264 command, created as part of target creation.
4265
4266 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4267 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4268 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4269 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4270 to be much more board-specific.
4271 The key steps you use might look something like this
4272
4273 @example
4274 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4275 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4276 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4277 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4278 @end example
4279
4280 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4281 on-chip SRAM.
4282 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4283 writes to target memory;
4284 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4285 GDB memory checksumming;
4286 and more.
4287
4288 @quotation Warning
4289 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4290 inaccessible when application code
4291 (such as an operating system)
4292 enables or disables the MMU.
4293 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4294 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4295 easy access to other addresses needed.
4296 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4297 @end quotation
4298
4299 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4300 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4301 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4302 controllers.
4303 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4304 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4305 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4306
4307 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4308 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4309 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4310 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4311 purposes including additional configuration.
4312
4313 @itemize @bullet
4314 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4315 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4316 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4317 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4318
4319 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4320 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4321 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4322 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4323 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4324 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4325 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4326
4327 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4328 @end itemize
4329 @end deffn
4330
4331 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4332 The options accepted by this command may also be
4333 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4334 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4335 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4336
4337 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4338 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4339 and changing its endianness.
4340
4341 @itemize @bullet
4342
4343 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4344 used to access this target.
4345
4346 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4347 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4348
4349 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4350 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4351 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4352 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4353 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4354 same event name assigns only one handler.
4355
4356 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4357 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4358 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4359 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4360 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4361 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4362 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4363
4364 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4365 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4366 or virtual address is being used.
4367
4368 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4369 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4370
4371 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4372 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4373 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4374 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4375 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4376
4377 @anchor{rtostype}
4378 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4379 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4380 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}
4381 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4382
4383 @end itemize
4384 @end deffn
4385
4386 @section Other $target_name Commands
4387 @cindex object command
4388
4389 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4390 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4391
4392 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4393 Once a button is created a button
4394 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4395 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4396 configure it like this:
4397
4398 @example
4399 # Create
4400 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4401 # Modify
4402 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4403 # Query
4404 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4405 # Report
4406 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4407 @end example
4408
4409 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4410 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4411
4412 @example
4413 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4414 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4415 @end example
4416
4417 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4418
4419 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4420 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4421 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4422 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4423 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4424 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4425 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4426 They are not otherwise documented here.
4427 @end deffn
4428
4429 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4430 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4431 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4432 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4433 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4434 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4435 the target side uses raw memory.
4436
4437 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4438 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4439 The script orientation comes from working with data
4440 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4441 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4442 and neither store nor return those values.
4443
4444 @itemize
4445 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4446 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4447 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4448 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4449 @end itemize
4450 @end deffn
4451
4452 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4453 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4454 @command{$target_name configure}
4455 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4456 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4457 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4458 There are a few special cases:
4459
4460 @itemize @bullet
4461 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4462 event named @var{event_name}.
4463 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4464 two parameters.
4465 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4466 This is a special case because this is set using
4467 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4468 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4469 @end itemize
4470
4471 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4472 all the targets you might use something like this:
4473
4474 @example
4475 foreach name [target names] @{
4476 set y [$name cget -endian]
4477 set z [$name cget -type]
4478 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4479 $x $name $y $z]
4480 @}
4481 @end example
4482 @end deffn
4483
4484 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4485 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4486 Displays the current target state:
4487 @code{debug-running},
4488 @code{halted},
4489 @code{reset},
4490 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4491 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4492 @end deffn
4493
4494 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4495 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4496 currently associated with this target.
4497 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4498 @end deffn
4499
4500 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4501 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4502 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4503 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4504 @end deffn
4505
4506 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4507 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4508 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4509 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4510 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4511 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4512 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4513 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4514 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4515 @end deffn
4516
4517 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4518 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4519 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4520 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4521 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4522 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4523 @end deffn
4524
4525 @anchor{targetevents}
4526 @section Target Events
4527 @cindex target events
4528 @cindex events
4529 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4530 For example:
4531 @itemize @bullet
4532 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4533 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4534 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4535 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4536 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4537 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4538 to set up system clocks or
4539 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4540 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4541 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4542 @end itemize
4543
4544 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4545 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4546 @command{target create ... -event}.
4547
4548 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4549 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4550 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4551
4552 @example
4553 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4554 echo "Reset..."
4555 reset halt
4556 @}
4557 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4558 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4559 echo "Reset..."
4560 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work we need a reset init.
4561 reset init
4562 @}
4563 @end example
4564
4565 The following target events are defined:
4566
4567 @itemize @bullet
4568 @item @b{debug-halted}
4569 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4570 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4571 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4572 @item @b{early-halted}
4573 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4574 @item @b{examine-start}
4575 @* Before target examine is called.
4576 @item @b{examine-end}
4577 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4578 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4579 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4580 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4581 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4582 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4583 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4584 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4585 @* When GDB disconnects
4586 @item @b{gdb-end}
4587 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4588 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4589 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4590 @code{reset init})
4591 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4592 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4593 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4594 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4595 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4596 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4597 @item @b{gdb-start}
4598 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4599 @item @b{halted}
4600 @* The target has halted
4601 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4602 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4603 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4604 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4605 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4606 @item @b{reset-assert}
4607 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4608 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4609 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4610 it instead of asserting SRST.
4611 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4612 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4613 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4614 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4615 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4616 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4617 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4618 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4619 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4620 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4621 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4622 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4623 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4624 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4625 released on the scan chain.
4626 @item @b{reset-end}
4627 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4628 @ignore
4629 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4630 @* Currently not used
4631 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4632 @* Currently not used
4633 @end ignore
4634 @item @b{reset-init}
4635 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4636 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4637
4638 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4639 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4640 multiplexing, and so on.
4641 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4642 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4643 @item @b{reset-start}
4644 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4645 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4646
4647 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4648 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4649 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4650 @ignore
4651 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4652 @* Currently not used
4653 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4654 @* Currently not used
4655 @end ignore
4656 @item @b{resume-start}
4657 @* Before any target is resumed
4658 @item @b{resume-end}
4659 @* After all targets have resumed
4660 @item @b{resumed}
4661 @* Target has resumed
4662 @end itemize
4663
4664 @node Flash Commands
4665 @chapter Flash Commands
4666
4667 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4668 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4669 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4670 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4671 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4672 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4673 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4674 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4675 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4676
4677 Flash Steps:
4678 @enumerate
4679 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4680 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4681 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4682 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4683 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4684 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4685 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4686 @item GDB Flashing
4687 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4688 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4689 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4690 @end enumerate
4691
4692 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4693 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4694 so that it can't boot.
4695 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4696 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4697
4698 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4699 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4700 @cindex flash configuration
4701
4702 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4703 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4704 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4705 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4706 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4707 see the driver-specific documentation.
4708
4709 @itemize @bullet
4710 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4711 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4712 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4713 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4714 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4715 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4716 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4717 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4718 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4719 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4720 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4721 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4722 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4723 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4724 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4725 commands to the flash controller.
4726 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4727 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4728 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4729 for more information.
4730 @end itemize
4731 @quotation Note
4732 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4733 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4734 @end quotation
4735 @end deffn
4736
4737 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4738 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4739 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4740 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4741 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4742 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4743 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4744 @end deffn
4745
4746 @deffn Command {flash list}
4747 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4748 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4749 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4750 @end deffn
4751
4752 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4753 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4754 depends on the flash type.
4755 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4756 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4757 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4758 but most don't bother.
4759 @end deffn
4760
4761 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4762 @cindex flash erasing
4763 @cindex flash reading
4764 @cindex flash writing
4765 @cindex flash programming
4766 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4767
4768 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4769 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4770 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4771 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4772 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4773
4774 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4775 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4776 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4777 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4778 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4779
4780 @quotation Note
4781 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4782 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4783 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4784 back to a flash bank.
4785 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4786 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4787 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4788 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4789 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4790 @end quotation
4791
4792 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4793 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4794 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4795 disabled first.
4796 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4797 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4798 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4799
4800 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4801 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4802 up to and including @var{last}.
4803 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4804 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4805 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4806 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4807 @end deffn
4808
4809 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4810 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4811 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4812 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4813 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4814 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4815 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4816 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4817 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4818 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4819 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4820 before erase starts.
4821 @end deffn
4822
4823 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4824 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4825 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4826 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4827 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4828 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4829 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4830 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4831 before issuing this command.
4832 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4833 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4834 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4835 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4836 @end deffn
4837 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4838
4839 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4840 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4841 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4842 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4843 @end deffn
4844
4845 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4846 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4847 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4848 to the base address for each section in the image.
4849 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4850 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4851 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4852 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4853 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4854 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4855 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4856 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4857 each image section.
4858
4859 @quotation Warning
4860 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4861 data you want to preserve.
4862 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4863 sections might be erased with no notice.
4864 @itemize
4865 @item
4866 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4867 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4868 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4869 @item
4870 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4871 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4872 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4873 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4874 @end itemize
4875 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4876 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4877 @end quotation
4878
4879 @end deffn
4880
4881 @section Other Flash commands
4882 @cindex flash protection
4883
4884 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4885 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4886 and display that status.
4887 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4888 @end deffn
4889
4890 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4891 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4892 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4893 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4894 and possibly stale information.
4895 @end deffn
4896
4897 @anchor{flashprotect}
4898 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4899 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4900 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4901 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4902 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4903 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4904 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4905 @end deffn
4906
4907 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4908 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4909 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4910 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4911 @end deffn
4912
4913 @anchor{program}
4914 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [offset]
4915 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4916 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4917 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4918 @end deffn
4919
4920 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4921 @section Flash Driver List
4922 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4923 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4924 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4925
4926 @subsection External Flash
4927
4928 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4929 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4930 @cindex CFI
4931 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4932 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4933 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4934 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4935 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4936 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4937 configure a bus and its timings), or
4938 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4939 on the flash chip.
4940 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4941 speed up operation.
4942
4943 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4944
4945 @itemize
4946 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4947 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4948 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4949 @end itemize
4950
4951 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4952 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4953
4954 @example
4955 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4956 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4957 @end example
4958
4959 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4960 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4961 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4962
4963 @example
4964 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4965 @end example
4966
4967 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4968 @end deffn
4969
4970 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4971 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4972 @cindex SPIFI
4973 @cindex lpcspifi
4974 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4975 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4976 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4977
4978 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4979 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4980 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4981 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4982 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4983
4984 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4985 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4986 are configured by the driver.
4987
4988 @example
4989 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4990 @end example
4991
4992 @end deffn
4993
4994 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4995 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4996 @cindex SMI
4997 @cindex stmsmi
4998 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4999 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5000 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5001 SPI flash devices.
5002 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5003 flash devices can be connected.
5004
5005 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5006 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5007 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5008 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5009 the flash content.
5010
5011 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5012 to identify the memory bank.
5013 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5014 flash size, are detected automatically.
5015
5016 @example
5017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5018 @end example
5019
5020 @end deffn
5021
5022 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5023
5024 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5025 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5026 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5027 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5028 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5029 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5030
5031 @example
5032 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5033 @end example
5034 @end deffn
5035
5036 @anchor{at91samd}
5037 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5038 @cindex at91samd
5039
5040 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5041 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5042 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5043 processor to be halted.
5044 @end deffn
5045
5046 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5047 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5048 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5049 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5050 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5051 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5052
5053 @example
5054 at91samd set-security enable
5055 @end example
5056 @end deffn
5057
5058 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5059 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5060 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5061 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5062 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5063 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5064 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5065 in order to disable this feature.
5066
5067 @example
5068 at91samd eeprom
5069 at91samd eeprom 1024
5070 @end example
5071 @end deffn
5072
5073 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5074 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5075 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5076 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5077 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5078 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5079
5080 @example
5081 at91samd bootloader
5082 at91samd bootloader 16384
5083 @end example
5084 @end deffn
5085
5086 @end deffn
5087
5088 @anchor{at91sam3}
5089 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5090 @cindex at91sam3
5091 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5092 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5093 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5094 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5095 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5096 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5097 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5098 chips are confirmed.}
5099
5100 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5101 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5102 the following fixed locations:
5103
5104 @example
5105 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5106 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5107 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5108 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5109 @end example
5110
5111 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5112 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5113 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5114
5115 @itemize
5116 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5117 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5118 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5119 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5120 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5121 @end itemize
5122
5123 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5124
5125 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5126 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5127 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5128 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5129 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5130 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5131 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5132
5133 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5134 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5135 @end deffn
5136
5137 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5138 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5139 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5140 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5141 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5142 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5143 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5144 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5145 @end deffn
5146
5147 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5148 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5149 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5150 @end deffn
5151 @end deffn
5152
5153 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5154 @cindex at91sam4
5155 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5156 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5157 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5158 @end deffn
5159
5160 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5161 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5162 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5163 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5164 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5165
5166 @example
5167 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5168 @end example
5169
5170 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5171 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5172
5173 @itemize
5174 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5175 @item @var{banks}
5176 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5177 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5178 @item @var{pages_size}
5179 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5180 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5181 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5182 @end itemize
5183
5184 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5185 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5186 will be autoconfigured.
5187 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5188
5189 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5190 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5191 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5192 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5193 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5194
5195 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5196 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5197 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5198 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5199 are not truly general purpose).
5200 @quotation Note
5201 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5202 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5203 @end quotation
5204 @end deffn
5205 @end deffn
5206
5207 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5208 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5209 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5210 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5211 @end deffn
5212
5213 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5214 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5215 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5216 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5217 autoconfigures itself.
5218 @example
5219 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5220 @end example
5221 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5222 supported.}
5223 @end deffn
5224
5225 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5226 All members of the LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members
5227 of the LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000 and LPC4300 microcontroller families from NXP
5228 include internal flash and use Cortex-M0 (LPC11(x)00), Cortex-M3 (LPC1300, LPC1700,
5229 LPC1800), Cortex-M4 (LPC4300) or ARM7TDMI (LPC2000) cores.
5230
5231 @quotation Note
5232 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5233 driver:
5234 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5235 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5236 @end quotation
5237
5238 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5239 which must appear in the following order:
5240
5241 @itemize
5242 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5243 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5244 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5245 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x)
5246 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5247 LPC43x[2357])
5248 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5249 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5250 LPC1300 and LPC1700
5251 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5252 at which the core is running
5253 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5254 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5255 @quotation Note
5256 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5257 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5258 However, if you do provide it,
5259 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5260 @end quotation
5261 @end itemize
5262
5263 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5264
5265 @example
5266 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5267 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5268 @end example
5269
5270 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5271 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5272 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5273 @end deffn
5274 @end deffn
5275
5276 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5277 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5278 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5279 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5280 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5281 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5282
5283 @example
5284 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5285 @end example
5286 @end deffn
5287
5288 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5289 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5290 from NXP.
5291
5292 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5293 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5294 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5295 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5296 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5297 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5298 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5299 you start the PLL.
5300
5301 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5302
5303 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5304 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5305 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5306
5307 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5308 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5309 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5310 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5311 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5312 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5313 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5314
5315 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5316 @example
5317 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5318 @end example
5319
5320 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5321 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5322 @code{flash banks} command.
5323
5324 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5325 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5326 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5327 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5328 a known signature.
5329 Example:
5330 @example
5331 lpc2900 signature 0
5332 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5333 @end example
5334 @end deffn
5335
5336 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5337 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5338 saves it to a file in binary format.
5339 Example:
5340 @example
5341 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5342 @end example
5343 @end deffn
5344
5345 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5346 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5347 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5348 command:
5349
5350 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5351 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5352 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5353 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5354
5355 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5356 Example:
5357 @example
5358 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5359 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5360 @end example
5361 @end deffn
5362
5363 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5364 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5365 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5366 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5367 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5368 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5369 912 bytes.
5370 @quotation Attention
5371 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5372 @end quotation
5373 Example:
5374 @example
5375 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5376 @end example
5377 @end deffn
5378
5379 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5380 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5381 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5382 after the next power cycle.
5383 @quotation Attention
5384 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5385 @end quotation
5386 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5387 Example:
5388 @example
5389 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5390 flash info 0
5391 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5392 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5393 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5394 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5395 @end example
5396 @end deffn
5397
5398 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5399 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5400 effective after the next power cycle.
5401 @quotation Attention
5402 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5403 @end quotation
5404 Examples:
5405 @example
5406 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5407 @end example
5408 @end deffn
5409 @end deffn
5410
5411 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5412 @emph{No idea what this is, other than using some arm7/arm9 core.}
5413
5414 @example
5415 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5416 @end example
5417 @end deffn
5418
5419 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5420 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5421 and integrate flash memory.
5422
5423 @example
5424 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5425 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5426 @end example
5427
5428 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5429 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5430 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5431 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5432 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5433 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5434 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5435 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5436 @end deffn
5437 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5438 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5439 This will remove any Code Protection.
5440 @end deffn
5441 @end deffn
5442
5443 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5444 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx microcontroller family from
5445 Texas Instruments
5446 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5447 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5448 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5449 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5450 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5451 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5452
5453 @example
5454 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5455 @end example
5456
5457 @deffn Command {stellaris recover bank_id}
5458 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to
5459 restore the flash specified by @var{bank_id} and its associated
5460 nonvolatile registers to their factory default values (erased).
5461 This is the only way to remove flash protection or re-enable
5462 debugging if that capability has been disabled.
5463
5464 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5465 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5466 @quotation Warning
5467 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5468 applied to all of them.
5469 @end quotation
5470 @end deffn
5471 @end deffn
5472
5473 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5474 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5475 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5476 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5477 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5478
5479 @example
5480 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5481 @end example
5482
5483 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5484 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5485 the flash driver.
5486
5487 @example
5488 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5489 @end example
5490
5491 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5492 as per the following example.
5493 @example
5494 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5495 @end example
5496
5497 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5498 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5499 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5500 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5501 are defined:
5502
5503 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5504 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5505 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5506 @end deffn
5507
5508 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5509 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5510 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5511 @end deffn
5512
5513 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5514 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5515 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5516 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5517 @end deffn
5518
5519 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5520 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5521 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5522 @end deffn
5523 @end deffn
5524
5525 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5526 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5527 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5528 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5529 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5530
5531 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5532 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5533 the flash driver.
5534
5535 @example
5536 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5537 @end example
5538
5539 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5540
5541 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5542 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5543 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5544 @end deffn
5545
5546 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5547 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5548 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5549 @end deffn
5550 @end deffn
5551
5552 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5553 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5554 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5555 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5556 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5557
5558 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5559 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5560 the flash driver.
5561
5562 @example
5563 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5564 @end example
5565 @end deffn
5566
5567 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5568 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5569 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5570 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5571 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5572
5573 @example
5574 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5575 @end example
5576
5577 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5578 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5579 for the specified flash bank.
5580 @end deffn
5581 @end deffn
5582
5583 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5584 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5585 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5586 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5587 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5588
5589 @example
5590 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5591 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5592 @end example
5593
5594 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5595 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5596 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5597
5598 @itemize @bullet
5599 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5600 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5601 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5602 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5603 @end itemize
5604 @end deffn
5605
5606 @end deffn
5607
5608 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5609 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5610 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5611 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5612
5613 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5614
5615 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5616 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5617 @end deffn
5618
5619 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5620 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5621 @end deffn
5622
5623 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5624 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5625 the flash clock.
5626 @end deffn
5627 @end deffn
5628
5629 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5630 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5631 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5632
5633 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5634
5635 @itemize
5636 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5637 @end itemize
5638
5639 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5640 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
5641 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
5642 @example
5643 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5644 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5645 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5646 @end example
5647 @end deffn
5648
5649 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5650 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5651 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5652 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5653 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5654 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5655 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5656
5657 @example
5658 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5659 @end example
5660 @end deffn
5661
5662 @subsection str9xpec driver
5663 @cindex str9xpec
5664
5665 Here is some background info to help
5666 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5667 the str9:
5668 @enumerate
5669 @item
5670 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5671 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5672 @item
5673 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5674 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5675 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5676 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5677 @end enumerate
5678
5679 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5680 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5681 configured for flash bank 0.
5682 @example
5683 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5684 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5685 jtag_reset 0 1
5686 # turn off target polling
5687 poll off
5688 # disable str9 core
5689 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5690 # read option bytes
5691 str9xpec options_read 0
5692 # re-enable str9 core
5693 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5694 poll on
5695 reset halt
5696 @end example
5697 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5698 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5699 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5700 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5701
5702 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5703 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5704 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5705 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5706 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5707
5708 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5709
5710 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5711 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5712 @end deffn
5713
5714 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5715 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5716 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5717 @end deffn
5718
5719 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5720 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5721 erase the device.
5722 @end deffn
5723
5724 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5725 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5726 @end deffn
5727
5728 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5729 Configure str9 boot bank.
5730 @end deffn
5731
5732 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5733 Configure str9 lvd source.
5734 @end deffn
5735
5736 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5737 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5738 @end deffn
5739
5740 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5741 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5742 @end deffn
5743
5744 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5745 Read str9 option bytes.
5746 @end deffn
5747
5748 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5749 Write str9 option bytes.
5750 @end deffn
5751
5752 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5753 unlock str9 device.
5754 @end deffn
5755
5756 @end deffn
5757
5758 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5759 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5760 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5761
5762 @example
5763 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5764 @end example
5765
5766 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5767
5768 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5769 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5770 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5771 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5772 code.
5773 @end deffn
5774 @end deffn
5775
5776 @section mFlash
5777
5778 @subsection mFlash Configuration
5779 @cindex mFlash Configuration
5780
5781 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
5782 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
5783 address @var{base}.
5784 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
5785 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
5786
5787 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
5788
5789 @example
5790 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
5791 @end example
5792
5793 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
5794
5795 @example
5796 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
5797 @end example
5798 @end deffn
5799
5800 @subsection mFlash commands
5801 @cindex mFlash commands
5802
5803 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
5804 Configure mflash PLL.
5805 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
5806 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
5807 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
5808 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
5809 @end deffn
5810
5811 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
5812 Configure bootable option.
5813 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
5814 (4kB) for boot.
5815 @end deffn
5816
5817 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
5818 Configure storage information.
5819 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
5820 written.
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
5824 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
5825 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
5826 @end deffn
5827
5828 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
5829 Probe mflash.
5830 @end deffn
5831
5832 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
5833 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
5834 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
5835 @end deffn
5836
5837 @node Flash Programming
5838 @chapter Flash Programming
5839
5840 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
5841 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5842 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5843
5844 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
5845 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and shutdown.
5846
5847 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
5848 @enumerate
5849 @item 'init' is executed.
5850 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
5851 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
5852 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
5853 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
5854 @item OpenOCD is shutdown.
5855 @end enumerate
5856
5857 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
5858
5859 @example
5860 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
5861 # are optional parameters
5862 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
5863 -c "program filename.elf verify reset"
5864
5865 # binary files need the flash address passing
5866 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
5867 -c "program filename.bin 0x08000000"
5868 @end example
5869
5870 @node NAND Flash Commands
5871 @chapter NAND Flash Commands
5872 @cindex NAND
5873
5874 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5875 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5876 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5877
5878 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5879 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5880 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5881 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5882 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5883 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5884
5885 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5886 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5887 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5888 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5889 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5890 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5891 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5892 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5893 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5894 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5895
5896 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5897 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5898 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5899 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5900 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5901 every 512 bytes of data.
5902
5903 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5904 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5905 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5906 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5907 ECC mode is used.
5908
5909 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5910 @enumerate
5911 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5912 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5913 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5914 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5915 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5916 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5917 to access that device.
5918 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5919 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5920 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5921 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5922 de-brick a board.
5923 @end enumerate
5924
5925 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5926 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5927 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5928 are only 32 bits wide.
5929 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5930 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5931 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5932 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5933
5934 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5935 @section NAND Configuration Commands
5936 @cindex NAND configuration
5937
5938 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5939 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5940 OpenOCD has initialized.
5941
5942 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5943 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5944 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5945 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5946 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5947 they were a single (larger) device.
5948 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5949 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5950
5951 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5952 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5953 configuration files, not interactively.
5954
5955 @itemize @bullet
5956 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5957 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5958 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5959 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5960 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5961 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5962 commands to the NAND controller.
5963 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5964 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5965 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5966 for more information.
5967 @end itemize
5968 @end deffn
5969
5970 @deffn Command {nand list}
5971 Prints a summary of each device declared
5972 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5973 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5974 @example
5975 > nand list
5976 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5977 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5978 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5979 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5980 >
5981 @end example
5982 @end deffn
5983
5984 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5985 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5986 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5987 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5988 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5989 it with most other NAND commands.
5990 @end deffn
5991
5992 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5993
5994 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5995 @cindex NAND reading
5996 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5997 starting at the specified offset.
5998 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5999
6000 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6001 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6002
6003 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6004 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6005 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6006
6007 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6008 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6009 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6010 method which handled that error correction.
6011
6012 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6013 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6014 @itemize @bullet
6015 @item no oob_* parameter
6016 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6017 @item @code{oob_raw}
6018 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6019 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6020 spare areas associated with each data page.
6021 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6022 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6023 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6024 @item @code{oob_only}
6025 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6026 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6027 spare areas associated with each data page.
6028 @end itemize
6029 @end deffn
6030
6031 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6032 @cindex NAND erasing
6033 @cindex NAND programming
6034 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6035 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6036 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6037 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6038 If those parameters are not specified,
6039 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6040 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6041
6042 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6043 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6044 block marker.
6045 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6046 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6047 @end deffn
6048
6049 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6050 @cindex NAND writing
6051 @cindex NAND programming
6052 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6053 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6054 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6055 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6056
6057 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6058 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6059
6060 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6061 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6062 past the end of the device.
6063 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6064 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6065 if that's being written.)
6066
6067 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6068 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6069 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6070
6071 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6072 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6073 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6074 @itemize @bullet
6075 @item no oob_* parameter
6076 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6077 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6078 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6079 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6080 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6081 @item @code{oob_only}
6082 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6083 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6084 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6085 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6086 @item @code{oob_raw}
6087 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6088 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6089 un-altered OOB.
6090 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6091 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6092 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6093 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6094 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6095 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6096 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6097 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6098 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6099 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6100 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6101 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6102 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6103 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6104 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6105 @end itemize
6106 @end deffn
6107
6108 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6109 @cindex NAND verification
6110 @cindex NAND programming
6111 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6112 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6113 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6114
6115 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6116 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6117
6118 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6119 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6120 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6121 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6122 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6123
6124 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6125 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6126 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6127
6128 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6129 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6130 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6131 be removed in a future release.
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @section Other NAND commands
6135 @cindex NAND other commands
6136
6137 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6138 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6139 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6140 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6141 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6142 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6143 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6144 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6145
6146 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6147 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6148 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6149 @end deffn
6150
6151 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6152 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6153 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6154 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6155 status for each block.
6156 @end deffn
6157
6158 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6159 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6160 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6161
6162 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6163 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6164 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6165 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6166 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6167
6168 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6169 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6170 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6171 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6172 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6173 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6174 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6175 @end deffn
6176
6177 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6178 @section NAND Driver List
6179 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6180 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6181 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6182
6183 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6184 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6185 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6186 address of the ECC controller.
6187 @example
6188 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6189 @end example
6190 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6191 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6192 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6193 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6194 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6195 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6196 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6197 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6198 @end deffn
6199 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6200 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6201 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6202 @end deffn
6203
6204 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6205 properly configured for input or output.
6206 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6207 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6208 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6209 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6210 @end deffn
6211 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6212 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6213 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6214 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6215 @end deffn
6216 @end deffn
6217
6218 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6219 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6220 chips from Texas Instruments.
6221 It takes three extra parameters:
6222 address of the NAND chip;
6223 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6224 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6225 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6226 @example
6227 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6228 @end example
6229 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6230 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6231 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6232 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6233 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6234 @end deffn
6235
6236 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6237 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6238 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6239 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6240 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6241 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6242 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6243 @end deffn
6244
6245 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6246 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6247 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6248 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6249 @end deffn
6250 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6251
6252 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6253 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6254 should work for this chip aswell.
6255 @end deffn
6256
6257 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6258 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6259 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6260 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6261 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6262 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6263 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6264 @example
6265 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6266 @end example
6267 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6268 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6269 without parameter query status.
6270 @end deffn
6271 @end deffn
6272
6273 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6274 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6275 parameter: the address of the controller.
6276 @example
6277 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6278 @end example
6279 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6280 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6281 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6282 change any behavior.
6283 @end deffn
6284
6285 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6286 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6287 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6288 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6289 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6290 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6291 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6292 specialized commands.
6293 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6294 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6295 change any behavior.
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6299 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6300 @cindex PLD
6301 @cindex FPGA
6302
6303 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6304 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6305 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6306 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6307 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6308 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6309 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6310
6311 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6312
6313 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6314 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6315 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6316
6317 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6318 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6319
6320 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6321 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6322 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6323 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6324 behavior.
6325 @end deffn
6326
6327 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6328 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6329 @end deffn
6330
6331 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6332 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6333 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6334 @end deffn
6335
6336 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6337
6338 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6339 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6340 that particular type of PLD.
6341
6342 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2
6343 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6344 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6345 No driver-specific PLD definition options are used,
6346 and one driver-specific command is defined.
6347
6348 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6349 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6350 for FPGA @var{num}.
6351 @end deffn
6352 @end deffn
6353
6354 @node General Commands
6355 @chapter General Commands
6356 @cindex commands
6357
6358 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6359 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6360 commands are documented elsewhere.
6361
6362 Intent:
6363 @itemize @bullet
6364 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6365 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6366 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6367 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6368
6369 @item @b{From the human}
6370 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6371 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6372
6373 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6374 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6375 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6376
6377 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6378 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6379 port is 5555.
6380 @end itemize
6381
6382
6383 @section Daemon Commands
6384
6385 @deffn {Command} exit
6386 Exits the current telnet session.
6387 @end deffn
6388
6389 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6390 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6391 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6392 Not every command provides helptext.
6393
6394 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6395 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6396 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6397 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6398 @end deffn
6399
6400 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6401 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6402 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6403 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6404 Useful in connection with script files
6405 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6406 @end deffn
6407
6408 @deffn Command shutdown
6409 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet, other).
6410 @end deffn
6411
6412 @anchor{debuglevel}
6413 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6414 @cindex message level
6415 Display debug level.
6416 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6417 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6418 Level 0 is error messages only;
6419 level 1 adds warnings;
6420 level 2 adds informational messages;
6421 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6422 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6423 the command line along with the location of that log
6424 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6425 @xref{Running}.
6426 @end deffn
6427
6428 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6429 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6430 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6431 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6432 @example
6433 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6434 @end example
6435 @end deffn
6436
6437 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6438 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6439 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6443 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6444 @end deffn
6445
6446 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6447 @section Target State handling
6448 @cindex reset
6449 @cindex halt
6450 @cindex target initialization
6451
6452 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6453 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6454 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6455 a current target which is used to perform the
6456 various operations. The current target may be changed
6457 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6458 target which should become current.
6459
6460 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6461 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6462 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6463 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6464 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6465
6466 @emph{With no arguments}:
6467 list all available registers for the current target,
6468 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6469 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6470 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6471 are flagged as such.
6472
6473 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6474 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6475 bypassing any internal cache.
6476
6477 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6478 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6479 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6480 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6481 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6482 relevant module will flush such values.
6483
6484 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6485 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6486
6487 @example
6488 > reg
6489 ===== ARM registers
6490 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6491 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6492 (2) r2 (/32)
6493 ...
6494 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6495 >
6496 @end example
6497 @end deffn
6498
6499 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6500 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6501 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6502 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6503 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6504 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6505 (and enter debug mode).
6506 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6507
6508 @quotation Warning
6509 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6510 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6511 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6512 power mode by gating the core clock;
6513 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6514
6515 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6516 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6517 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6518 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6519 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6520 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6521
6522 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6523 work with a JTAG debugger.
6524 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6525 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6526 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6527 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6528 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6529 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6530 @end quotation
6531
6532 @end deffn
6533
6534 @deffn Command resume [address]
6535 Resume the target at its current code position,
6536 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6537 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6538 @end deffn
6539
6540 @deffn Command step [address]
6541 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6542 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @anchor{resetcommand}
6546 @deffn Command reset
6547 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6548 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6549 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6550 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6551 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6552 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6553
6554 The optional parameter specifies what should
6555 happen after the reset.
6556 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6557 The other options will not work on all systems.
6558 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6559
6560 @itemize @minus
6561 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6562 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6563 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6564 @end itemize
6565 @end deffn
6566
6567 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6568 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6569 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6570 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6571 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6572 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6573 state.
6574 @end deffn
6575
6576 @section I/O Utilities
6577
6578 These commands are available when
6579 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6580 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6581 notably the ZY1000.
6582 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6583
6584 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6585
6586 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6587 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6588 the text file @file{filename}.
6589 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6590 The last string is followed by a newline.
6591 @end deffn
6592
6593 @deffn Command cat filename
6594 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6595 @end deffn
6596
6597 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6598 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6599 into @file{dest_filename}.
6600 @end deffn
6601
6602 @deffn Command ip
6603 @emph{No description provided.}
6604 @end deffn
6605
6606 @deffn Command ls
6607 @emph{No description provided.}
6608 @end deffn
6609
6610 @deffn Command mac
6611 @emph{No description provided.}
6612 @end deffn
6613
6614 @deffn Command meminfo
6615 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6616 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @deffn Command peek
6620 @emph{No description provided.}
6621 @end deffn
6622
6623 @deffn Command poke
6624 @emph{No description provided.}
6625 @end deffn
6626
6627 @deffn Command rm filename
6628 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6629 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6630 @end deffn
6631
6632 @deffn Command trunc filename
6633 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6634 @end deffn
6635
6636 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6637 @section Memory access commands
6638 @cindex memory access
6639
6640 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6641 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6642 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6643 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6644
6645 @enumerate
6646 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6647 to change the current target.
6648 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6649 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6650 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6651 @end enumerate
6652
6653 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6654 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6655 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6656 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6657 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6658 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6659 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6660 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6661 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6662 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6663 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6664 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6665 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6669 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6670 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6671 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6672 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6673 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6674 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6675 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6676 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6677 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6678 @end deffn
6679
6680 @anchor{imageaccess}
6681 @section Image loading commands
6682 @cindex image loading
6683 @cindex image dumping
6684
6685 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6686 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6687 binary file named @var{filename}.
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6691 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6692 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6693 @end deffn
6694
6695 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6696 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6697 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6698 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6699 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6700 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6701 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6702 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6703 separately.
6704 @end deffn
6705
6706 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6707 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6708 The file format may optionally be specified
6709 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6710 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6711 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6712 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6713 @example
6714 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6715 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6716 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6717 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin $address $length
6718 @}
6719 @end example
6720 @end deffn
6721
6722 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6723 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6724 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6725 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6726 The file format may optionally be specified
6727 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6728 @end deffn
6729
6730 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6731 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6732 The file format may optionally be specified
6733 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6734 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6735 @end deffn
6736
6737
6738 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6739 @cindex breakpoint
6740 @cindex watchpoint
6741
6742 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6743 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6744 watchpoints.
6745 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6746
6747 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6748 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6749 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6750 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6751 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6752 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6753
6754 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6755 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6756 @end deffn
6757
6758 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6759 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6763 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6767 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6768 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6769 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6770 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6771 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6772 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6773 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6774 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @section Misc Commands
6778
6779 @cindex profiling
6780 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6781 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6782 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6783 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6784 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6785 limit the address range.
6786 @end deffn
6787
6788 @deffn Command {version}
6789 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6790 @end deffn
6791
6792 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6793 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6794 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6798 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6799 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6800 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6801
6802 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6803 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6804 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6805 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6806
6807 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6808 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6809 @cindex tracing
6810 @cindex ETM
6811 @cindex ETB
6812
6813 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6814 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6815 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6816
6817 @itemize
6818 @item
6819 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6820 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6821 supports such an interface.
6822 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6823 and trace port support.)
6824 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6825 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6826 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6827 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6828 in the board-specific configuration file.
6829 @item
6830 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6831 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6832 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6833 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6834 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6835 @end itemize
6836
6837 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6838
6839 @quotation Issues
6840 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6841 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6842
6843 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6844 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6845 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6846 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6847 dummy trace port driver}.
6848
6849 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6850 as well as tracing only during specific states
6851 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6852
6853 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6854 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6855 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6856 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6857 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6858
6859 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6860 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6861 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6862 this original style of JTAG access.
6863 @end quotation
6864
6865 @subsection ETM Configuration
6866 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6867
6868 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6869 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6870 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6871
6872 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6873 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6874 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6875 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6876 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6877 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6878 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6879 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6880 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6881
6882 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6883 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6884 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6885
6886 @quotation Warning
6887 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6888 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6889 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6890 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6891 @end quotation
6892
6893 @quotation Note
6894 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6895 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6896 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6897 what CPU activities are traced.
6898 @end quotation
6899 @end deffn
6900
6901 @deffn Command {etm info}
6902 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6903 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6904 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6905 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6906 @end deffn
6907
6908 @deffn Command {etm status}
6909 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6910 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6911 Did trace data overflow?
6912 Was it triggered?
6913 @end deffn
6914
6915 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6916 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6917 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6918 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6919 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6920
6921 @itemize
6922 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6923 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6924 The value is one of
6925 @option{none} (save nothing),
6926 @option{data} (save data),
6927 @option{address} (save addresses),
6928 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6929 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6930 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6931 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6932 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6933 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6934 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6935 trace stream without an image of the code.
6936 @end itemize
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6940 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
6941 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
6942 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
6943 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
6944
6945 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
6946 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
6947 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
6951
6952 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
6953 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
6954 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
6955
6956 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
6957 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
6958 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
6959 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
6960 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
6961 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
6962 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
6963
6964 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
6965
6966 @itemize
6967 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
6968 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
6969 for instruction access within that function's body.
6970 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
6971 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
6972 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
6973 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
6974 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
6975 combining one of the above models with a counter.
6976 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
6977 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
6978 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
6979 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
6980 @item @emph{... more}
6981 @end itemize
6982
6983 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
6984 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
6985
6986 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
6987 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
6988 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
6989 @end deffn
6990
6991 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
6992 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
6993 @end deffn
6994
6995 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
6996 Opens an image file.
6997 @end deffn
6998
6999 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7000 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7001 @end deffn
7002
7003 @deffn Command {etm start}
7004 Starts trace data collection.
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7008 Stops trace data collection.
7009 @end deffn
7010
7011 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7012 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7013
7014 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7015
7016 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7017 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7018 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7019 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7020 any trace data collection.}
7021 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7022 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7023 @end deffn
7024 @end deffn
7025
7026 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7027 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7028 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7029 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7030 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7031 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7032 @end deffn
7033 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7034 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7035 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7036 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7037 trace trigger becomes active.
7038
7039 @itemize
7040 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7041 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7042 afterwards.
7043 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7044 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7045 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7046 what caused that event to happen.
7047 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7048 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7049 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7050 how the event caused trouble.
7051 @end itemize
7052 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7053 @end deffn
7054
7055 @end deffn
7056
7057 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7058 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7059 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7060 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7061 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7062
7063 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7064 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7065
7066 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7067 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7068 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7072 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7076 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7077 @end deffn
7078 @end deffn
7079
7080
7081 @section Generic ARM
7082 @cindex ARM
7083
7084 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7085 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7086 commands that may be available.
7087
7088 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7089 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7090 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7091 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7092 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7093 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7094 @end deffn
7095
7096 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7097 @cindex disassemble
7098 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7099 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7100 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7101 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7102 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7103 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7104 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7105
7106 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7107 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7108 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7109 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7110 with a handful of exceptions.
7111 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7112 @end deffn
7113
7114 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7115 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7116 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7117 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7118 and using the MCR instruction.
7119 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7120 an ARM register.)
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7124 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7125 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7126 and the MRC instruction.
7127 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7128 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7129 an ARM register.)
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7133 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7134 core mode if necessary.
7135 @end deffn
7136
7137 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7138 @cindex ARM semihosting
7139 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7140
7141 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7142 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7143 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7144 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7145 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7146 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7147 @end deffn
7148
7149 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7150 @cindex ARMv4
7151 @cindex ARMv5
7152
7153 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7154 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7155 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7156 variant.
7157
7158 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7159 @cindex ARM7
7160 @cindex ARM9
7161
7162 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7163 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7164 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7165 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7166
7167 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7168 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7169 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7170 instead of breakpoints.
7171 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7172
7173 This should be
7174 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7175 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7176 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7177 @end deffn
7178
7179 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7180 @cindex DCC
7181 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7182 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7183 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7184
7185 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7186 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7187 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7191 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7192 that don't check completion of the operation.
7193 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7194
7195 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7196 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7197 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7201 @cindex ARM720T
7202
7203 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7204 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7205 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7206 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7207
7208 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7209 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7210 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7211
7212 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7213 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7214 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7215 @end deffn
7216
7217 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7218 @cindex ARM9
7219
7220 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7221 integer processors.
7222 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7223
7224 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7225 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7226 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7227 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7228
7229 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7230 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7231 @cindex vector_catch
7232 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7233 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7234 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7235 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7236 to those hardware vectors.
7237
7238 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7239 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7240 vector catch hardware to intercept
7241 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7242 @option{none} of them,
7243 or a list with one or more of the following:
7244 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7245 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7249 @cindex ARM920T
7250
7251 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7252 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7253 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7254 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7255 and ARM9 commands.
7256
7257 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7258 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7259 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7260 @end deffn
7261
7262 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7263 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7264 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7265 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7266 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7267 (Not all registers can be written.)
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7271 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7272 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7273
7274 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7275 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7276 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7277 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7278 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7279 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7283 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7284 @end deffn
7285
7286 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7287 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7288 @end deffn
7289
7290 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7291 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7292
7293 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7294 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7295 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7296 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7297 and ARM9 commands.
7298
7299 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7300 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7301
7302 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7303 Print information about the caches found.
7304 @end deffn
7305
7306 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7307 @cindex ARM966E
7308
7309 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7310 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7311 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7312 and ARM9 commands.
7313
7314 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7315 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7316 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7317 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7318 ARM966E-S TRM.
7319 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7320 as required for BIST support.
7321 @end deffn
7322
7323 @subsection XScale specific commands
7324 @cindex XScale
7325
7326 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7327
7328 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7329 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7330 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7331 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7332 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7333 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7334 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7335
7336 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7337 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7338 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7339 the mini-IC.
7340
7341 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7342 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7343 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7344 code layout in memory:
7345 @example
7346 _vectors:
7347 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7348 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7349 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7350 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7351 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7352 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7353 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7354 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7355 .org 0x100
7356 .long real_reset_vector
7357 .long real_ui_handler
7358 .long real_swi_handler
7359 .long real_pf_abort
7360 .long real_data_abort
7361 .long 0 /* unused */
7362 .long real_irq_handler
7363 .long real_fiq_handler
7364 @end example
7365
7366 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7367 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7368 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7369 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7370 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7371 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7372 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7373 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7374 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7375 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7376 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7377 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7378 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7379 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7380 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7381 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7382 software.
7383
7384 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7385 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7386 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7387 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7388
7389 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7390 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7391 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7392 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7393 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7394 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7395 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7396 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7397 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7398
7399 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7400 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7401
7402 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7403 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7404 @end deffn
7405
7406 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7407 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7408 @end deffn
7409
7410 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7411 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7415 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7416 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7417 @end deffn
7418
7419 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7420 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7421 @end deffn
7422
7423 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7424 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7425 @end deffn
7426
7427 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7428 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7432 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7433 @end deffn
7434
7435 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7436 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7437 @end deffn
7438
7439 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7440 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7441 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7442 and modifying how it is emptied.
7443 @end deffn
7444
7445 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7446 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7447 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7448 The image @var{type} may be one of
7449 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7450 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7451 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7455 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7456 @cindex vector_catch
7457 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7458 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7459
7460 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7461 @example
7462 0x01 Trap Reset
7463 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7464 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7465 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7466 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7467 0x20 reserved
7468 0x40 Trap IRQ
7469 0x80 Trap FIQ
7470 @end example
7471 @end deffn
7472
7473 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7474 @cindex vector_table
7475
7476 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7477 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7478 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7479 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7480 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7481
7482 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7483
7484 @end deffn
7485
7486 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7487 @cindex ARMv6
7488
7489 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7490 @cindex ARM11
7491
7492 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7493 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7494 which is enabled by default.
7495 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7496 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7497 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7498 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7499 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7500 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7501 @end deffn
7502
7503 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7504 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7505 which is enabled by default.
7506 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7507 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7508 @end deffn
7509
7510 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7511 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7512 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7513 they are disabled by default.
7514 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7515 @end deffn
7516
7517 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7518 @cindex vector_catch
7519 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7520 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7521 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7522
7523 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7524 for certain hardware events.
7525 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7526 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7527 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7531 @cindex ARMv7
7532
7533 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7534 @cindex Debug Access Port
7535 @cindex DAP
7536 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7537 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7538 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7539
7540 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7541 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7542 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7543 @end deffn
7544
7545 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7546 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7547 @end deffn
7548
7549 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7550 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7551 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7552 @end deffn
7553
7554 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7555 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7556 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7557 @end deffn
7558
7559 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7560 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7561 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7562 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7563 @end deffn
7564
7565 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7566 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7567 Defaulting to 0.
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7571 @cindex Cortex-M
7572
7573 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7574 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7575
7576 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7577 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7578 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7579 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7580 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7581 the step command leaves with the core running.
7582
7583 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7584 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7585 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7586
7587 Default is @option{auto}.
7588 @end deffn
7589
7590 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7591 @cindex vector_catch
7592 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7593 for certain hardware events.
7594
7595 Parameters request interception of
7596 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7597 @option{none} of them,
7598 or one or more of the following:
7599 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7600 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7601 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7602 @option{irq_err},
7603 @option{state_err},
7604 @option{chk_err}, or
7605 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7606 @option{reset}.
7607 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7608 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7609 are mapped to HardFault.
7610 UsageFault checks for
7611 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7612 must also be explicitly enabled.
7613
7614 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7615 @end deffn
7616
7617 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7618 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7619 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7620 @itemize @minus
7621 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7622 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7623 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7624 @end itemize
7625 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7626 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7627 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7628 the peripherals.
7629 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @section Intel Architecture
7633
7634 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7635 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7636 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7637 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7638 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7639 @itemize
7640 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7641 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7642 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7643 @end itemize
7644
7645 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7646 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7647 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7648
7649 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7650 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7651 @end deffn
7652
7653 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7654 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7655 @end deffn
7656
7657 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7658 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7659 @end deffn
7660
7661 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7662 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7663 @end deffn
7664
7665 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7666 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7667 @end deffn
7668
7669 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7670 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7671 @end deffn
7672
7673 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7674
7675 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7676 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7677
7678 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7679 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7680 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7681 @end deffn
7682 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7683 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7684
7685 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7686
7687 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7688 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7689 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7690 @end deffn
7691
7692 @subsection Registers commands
7693 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7694 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7695 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7696
7697 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7698
7699 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7700 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7701 and "timer" groups.
7702
7703 @emph{example:}
7704 @example
7705 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7706 @end example
7707
7708
7709 @end deffn
7710 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7711 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7712
7713 @emph{group} can be "system",
7714 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7715 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7716 @end deffn
7717
7718 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7719 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7720 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7721 @cindex tracing
7722 @cindex libdcc
7723 @cindex DCC
7724 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7725 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7726 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7727 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7728
7729 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7730 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7731 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7732 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7733 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7734 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7735
7736 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7737 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7738 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7739 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7740 The target being debugged may
7741 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7742 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7743 each supported by a command:
7744
7745 @itemize
7746 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7747 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7748 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7749 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7750
7751 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7752 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7753 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7754
7755 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7756 and then displayed at any time.
7757 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7758
7759 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7760 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7761 @end itemize
7762
7763 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7764 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7765 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7766 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7767 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7768 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7769 does the same thing.
7770
7771 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7772 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7773 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7774 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7775 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7776
7777 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7778 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7779 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7780 @end deffn
7781
7782 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7783 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7784 in the order they triggered.
7785 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7786 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7787 history records.
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7791 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7792 they have been triggered.
7793 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7794 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7795 and associates it with that identifier.
7796
7797 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7798 are not related except by this command.
7799 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7800 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7801 @end deffn
7802
7803
7804 @node JTAG Commands
7805 @chapter JTAG Commands
7806 @cindex JTAG Commands
7807 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7808 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7809 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7810 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7811 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7812
7813 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7814 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7815
7816 @itemize @bullet
7817 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7818 devices such as a CPUs.
7819 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7820 standard state machine (in parallel)
7821 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7822 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7823 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7824 while the reading previous ones.
7825 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7826 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7827 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7828 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7829 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7830 registers.
7831 @end itemize
7832
7833 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7834
7835 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7836 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7837 the order of TAP state transitions.
7838 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7839 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7840 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7841 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7842 these commands are not available.
7843
7844 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7845 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7846 that specify the entire register.
7847 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
7848 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
7849 The return value holds the original value of each
7850 of those fields.
7851
7852 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
7853 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
7854 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
7855 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
7856 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
7857
7858 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
7859 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
7860
7861 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7862 in that state.
7863 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
7864 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7865 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7866
7867 @quotation Warning
7868 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
7869 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
7870 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
7871 data registers, which may have different lengths.
7872 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
7873 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
7874 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
7875 (by connecting a different scan chain).
7876 @end quotation
7877 @end deffn
7878
7879 @deffn Command {flush_count}
7880 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
7881 This may be used for performance tuning.
7882
7883 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
7884 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
7885 not change with the amount of data which is written.
7886 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
7887 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
7888 instead of batching them into larger operations.
7889 @end deffn
7890
7891 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7892 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
7893 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
7894 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
7895 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
7896 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
7897
7898 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7899 in that state.
7900 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
7901 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7902 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7903
7904 @quotation Note
7905 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
7906 register values, unlike data register values.
7907 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
7908 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
7909 @end quotation
7910 @end deffn
7911
7912 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
7913 Set values of reset signals.
7914 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
7915 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
7916 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
7917 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7918 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
7919 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7920 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7921
7922 Note that TRST is specially handled.
7923 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7924 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7925 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7926 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7927 instead of the TRST signal.
7928 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7929 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7930 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7931 with handlers for that event.
7932 @end deffn
7933
7934 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
7935 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
7936 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
7937 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
7938 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
7939 Then, in a series of single state transitions
7940 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
7941 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
7942 The final state must also be stable.
7943 @end deffn
7944
7945 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
7946 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
7947 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
7948 Instructions often need some time
7949 to execute before they take effect.
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
7953 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
7954
7955 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7956 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
7957 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
7958 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
7959 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
7960 @end deffn
7961
7962 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7963 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
7964 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
7965 must also be enabled.
7966 Default is enabled.
7967 @end deffn
7968
7969 @section TAP state names
7970 @cindex TAP state names
7971
7972 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
7973 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
7974 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
7975 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
7976
7977 @itemize @bullet
7978 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
7979 acts as if TRST were pulsed
7980 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
7981 @item @b{DRSELECT}
7982 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
7983 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
7984 through the data register
7985 @item @b{DREXIT1}
7986 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
7987 for update or more shifting
7988 @item @b{DREXIT2}
7989 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
7990 @item @b{IRSELECT}
7991 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
7992 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
7993 through the instruction register
7994 @item @b{IREXIT1}
7995 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
7996 for update or more shifting
7997 @item @b{IREXIT2}
7998 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
7999 @end itemize
8000
8001 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8002 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8003 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8004 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8005
8006 @itemize @bullet
8007 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8008 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8009 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8010 may not be as expected.
8011 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8012 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8013 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8014 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8015 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8016 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8017 @end itemize
8018
8019 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8020 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8021
8022 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8023 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8024 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8025 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8026
8027 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8028 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8029 @cindex SVF
8030
8031 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8032 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8033 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8034 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8035
8036 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8037 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8038 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8039 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8040 each command is logged before it is executed.
8041 @end deffn
8042
8043 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8044 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8045 @cindex XSVF
8046
8047 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8048 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8049 Xilinx devices.
8050 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8051 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8052
8053 @quotation Important
8054 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8055 @end quotation
8056
8057 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8058 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8059 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8060 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8061 that TAP.
8062 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8063 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8064 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8065 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8066 @end deffn
8067
8068 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8069 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8070 after building the software.
8071 You may find them useful:
8072
8073 @itemize
8074 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8075 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8076 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8077 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8078 @end itemize
8079
8080 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8081 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8082 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8083 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8084 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8085 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8086 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8087
8088
8089 @node Utility Commands
8090 @chapter Utility Commands
8091 @cindex Utility Commands
8092
8093 @section RAM testing
8094 @cindex RAM testing
8095
8096 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8097 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8098 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8099 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8100 hardware problems.
8101
8102 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8103 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8104 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8105 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8106
8107 Load the memory testing functions with
8108
8109 @example
8110 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8111 @end example
8112
8113 to get access to the following facilities:
8114
8115 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8116 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8117 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8118 @end deffn
8119
8120 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8121 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8122 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8123 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8124 @end deffn
8125
8126 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8127 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8128 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8129 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8130 @end deffn
8131
8132 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8133 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8134 @end deffn
8135
8136 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8137 @cindex Firmware recovery
8138
8139 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8140 devices recovery with JTAG.
8141
8142 For quickstart instructions run:
8143 @example
8144 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8145 @end example
8146
8147 @node TFTP
8148 @chapter TFTP
8149 @cindex TFTP
8150 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8151 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8152
8153 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8154 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8155 server (tftpd). For example,
8156
8157 @example
8158 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8159 @end example
8160
8161 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8162 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8163
8164 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8165 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8166 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8167 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8168
8169 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8170 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8171 @cindex GDB
8172 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8173 to debug remote targets.
8174 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8175
8176 @itemize
8177 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8178 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8179 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8180 as shown in this chapter.
8181 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8182 that also will probably need to be configured.
8183 @end itemize
8184
8185 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8186 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8187 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8188 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8189 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8190 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8191
8192 @section Connecting to GDB
8193 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8194 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8195 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8196 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8197 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8198
8199 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8200
8201 @enumerate
8202 @item
8203 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8204 @example
8205 target remote localhost:3333
8206 @end example
8207 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8208
8209 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8210 @example
8211 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8212 @end example
8213 @item
8214 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8215 @example
8216 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8217 @end example
8218 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8219 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8220 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8221 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8222 @end enumerate
8223
8224 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8225 GDB command line.
8226
8227 @section Sample GDB session startup
8228
8229 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8230 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8231 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8232 small ARM program.
8233 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8234 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8235
8236 @example
8237 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8238 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8239 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8240 ...
8241 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8242 ...
8243 (gdb) load
8244 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8245 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8246 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8247 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8248 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8249 (gdb) continue
8250 Continuing.
8251 ...
8252 @end example
8253
8254 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8255 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8256 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8257 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8258
8259 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8260
8261 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8262 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8263 packet size and the device's memory map.
8264 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8265 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8266 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8267
8268 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8269 You may need to set those up by hand.
8270 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8271 something like:
8272
8273 @example
8274 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8275 @end example
8276
8277 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8278
8279 @example
8280 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8281 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8282 @end example
8283
8284 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8285 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8286 do not have such restrictions.
8287
8288 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8289 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8290 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8291
8292 @example
8293 define hook-step
8294 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8295 end
8296 define hookpost-step
8297 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8298 end
8299 @end example
8300
8301 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8302 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8303 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8304 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8305
8306 @section Programming using GDB
8307 @cindex Programming using GDB
8308 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8309
8310 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8311 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8312 @example
8313 gdb_memory_map disable
8314 @end example
8315 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8316 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8317 working area.
8318
8319 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8320 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8321 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8322 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8323
8324 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8325 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8326
8327 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8328 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8329 @example
8330 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8331 @end example
8332
8333 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8334 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8335
8336 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8337 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8338 will be used.
8339
8340 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8341 script can be executed:
8342 @example
8343 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8344 @end example
8345
8346 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8347 can be used.
8348 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8349 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8350 @cindex SMP
8351 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8352 @itemize @bullet
8353 @item j - smp status request
8354 @item J - smp set request
8355 @end itemize
8356
8357 OpenOCD implements :
8358 @itemize @bullet
8359 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8360 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8361 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8362 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8363 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8364 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8365 @end itemize
8366
8367 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8368 @itemize @bullet
8369 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8370 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8371 @example
8372 set $_core 1
8373 #Jc01 packet is sent
8374 print $_core
8375 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8376 @end example
8377
8378 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8379 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8380
8381 @example
8382 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8383 define toggle0
8384 maint packet Jc0
8385 continue
8386 main packet Jc-1
8387 end
8388 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8389 define toggle1
8390 maint packet Jc1
8391 continue
8392 main packet Jc-1
8393 end
8394 @end example
8395 @end itemize
8396
8397 @section RTOS Support
8398 @cindex RTOS Support
8399 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8400
8401 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8402 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8403
8404 @* An example setup is below:
8405
8406 @example
8407 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8408 @end example
8409
8410 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8411
8412 Currently supported rtos's include:
8413 @itemize @bullet
8414 @item @option{eCos}
8415 @item @option{ThreadX}
8416 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8417 @item @option{linux}
8418 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8419 @item @option{embKernel}
8420 @end itemize
8421
8422 @quotation Note
8423 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8424 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8425 @end quotation
8426
8427 @table @code
8428 @item eCos symbols
8429 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8430 @item ThreadX symbols
8431 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8432 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8433 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8434 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8435 xTasksWaitingTermination, xSuspendedTaskList, uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8436 @item linux symbols
8437 init_task.
8438 @item ChibiOS symbols
8439 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8440 @item embKernel symbols
8441 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8442 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8443 @end table
8444
8445 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8446 some, eg. FreeRTOS @option{xTasksWaitingTermination} is only exported
8447 if @option{INCLUDE_vTaskDelete} is defined during the build.
8448
8449 @node Tcl Scripting API
8450 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8451 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8452 @cindex Tcl scripts
8453 @section API rules
8454
8455 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8456 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8457 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8458
8459 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8460 pair list and lists.
8461
8462 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8463 list.
8464
8465 @example
8466 > set foo(me) Duane
8467 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8468 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8469 > set foo(duck) Donald
8470 @end example
8471
8472 If one does this:
8473
8474 @example
8475 > set foo
8476 @end example
8477
8478 The result is:
8479
8480 @example
8481 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8482 @end example
8483
8484 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8485
8486 @verbatim
8487 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8488 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8489 }
8490 @end verbatim
8491
8492 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8493 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8494
8495 @section Internal low-level Commands
8496
8497 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8498 invoke directly.
8499
8500 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8501 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8502 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8503
8504 @itemize @bullet
8505 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8506
8507 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8508 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8509
8510 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8511 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8512
8513 Return information about the flash banks
8514
8515 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8516
8517 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8518 its execution. Example:
8519
8520 @example
8521 > capture "reset init"
8522 @end example
8523
8524 @end itemize
8525
8526 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8527 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8528 called "flash_banks".
8529
8530 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8531
8532 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8533 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8534 holds one of the following values:
8535
8536 @itemize @bullet
8537 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8538 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8539 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8540 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8541 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8542 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8543 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8544 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8545 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8546 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8547 @end itemize
8548
8549 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8550
8551 @quotation Note
8552 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8553 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8554 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8555 is jim, not real tcl).
8556 @end quotation
8557
8558 @section Tcl RPC server
8559 @cindex RPC
8560
8561 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8562 commands and receive the results.
8563
8564 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8565 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8566 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8567 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8568 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8569
8570 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8571 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8572 @command{capture} command.
8573
8574 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8575
8576 @node FAQ
8577 @chapter FAQ
8578 @cindex faq
8579 @enumerate
8580 @anchor{faqrtck}
8581 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8582 @cindex RTCK
8583 @cindex adaptive clocking
8584 @*
8585
8586 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8587 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8588 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8589 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8590
8591 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8592 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8593 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8594 @enumerate
8595 @item
8596 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8597 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8598 @item
8599 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8600 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8601 @end enumerate
8602
8603 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8604 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8605 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8606 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8607 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8608 power).
8609
8610 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8611 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8612 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8613 ARM926 scenario).
8614 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8615 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8616 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8617
8618 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8619 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8620 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8621 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8622
8623 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8624
8625 In order to make use of this,
8626 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8627 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8628
8629 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8630 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8631 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8632 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8633 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8634
8635 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8636 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8637 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8638 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8639
8640 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8641 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8642 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8643 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8644 with a CPLD.
8645 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8646 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8647 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8648 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8649 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8650 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8651
8652 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8653
8654 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8655
8656 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8657 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8658 depending on the chips on your board.
8659 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8660 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8661 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8662
8663 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8664 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8665 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8666
8667 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8668 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8669 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8670 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8671
8672 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8673 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8674 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8675 this way.
8676
8677 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8678 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8679 clock rate.
8680 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8681 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8682 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8683
8684 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8685
8686 @example
8687 # Example: 1.234MHz
8688 adapter_khz 1234
8689 @end example
8690
8691
8692 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8693
8694 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8695 around Windows filenames.
8696
8697 @example
8698 > echo \a
8699
8700 > echo @{\a@}
8701 \a
8702 > echo "\a"
8703
8704 >
8705 @end example
8706
8707
8708 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8709
8710 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8711 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8712 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8713
8714 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8715 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8716 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8717
8718 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8719 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8720 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8721
8722 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8723
8724 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8725 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8726 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8727 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8728
8729 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8730 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8731 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8732
8733 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8734 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8735
8736 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8737 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8738 memory read caused data abort".
8739
8740 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8741 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8742 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8743 be done, feel free to add this here.
8744
8745 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8746 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8747 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8748 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8749 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8750 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8751 gracefully stops.
8752
8753 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8754 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8755 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8756
8757 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8758 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8759 bytes. Painful...
8760
8761
8762 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8763 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8764
8765 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8766 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8767 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8768 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8769 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8770 reset, everything else should work fine.
8771
8772 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8773 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8774 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8775 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8776
8777 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8778 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8779 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8780 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8781
8782 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8783
8784 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
8785 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
8786 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
8787 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8788
8789 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
8790 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
8791 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
8792 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
8793
8794 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
8795 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
8796 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8797
8798 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
8799 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
8800
8801 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
8802 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
8803 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
8804 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
8805 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
8806 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
8807 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
8808 clock frequency?
8809
8810 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
8811 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
8812 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
8813 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
8814 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
8815
8816 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
8817
8818 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
8819 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
8820 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
8821 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
8822 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
8823 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
8824 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
8825
8826 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
8827
8828 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
8829 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
8830 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
8831 up DRAM and loading it with code.
8832
8833 @anchor{faqtaporder}
8834 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
8835 particular order?
8836
8837 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
8838 the same order used by the hardware.
8839
8840 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
8841 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
8842 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
8843 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
8844 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
8845 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
8846
8847 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
8848 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
8849 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
8850 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
8851
8852 @itemize @bullet
8853 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
8854 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
8855 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
8856 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
8857 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
8858 @end itemize
8859
8860 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
8861
8862 @itemize @bullet
8863 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
8864 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
8865 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
8866 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
8867 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
8868 @end itemize
8869
8870
8871 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
8872 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
8873 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
8874
8875 TODO.
8876
8877 @end enumerate
8878
8879 @node Tcl Crash Course
8880 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
8881 @cindex Tcl
8882
8883 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
8884 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
8885 how the Tcl scripts work.
8886
8887 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
8888 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
8889 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
8890 OpenOCD.
8891
8892 @section Tcl Rule #1
8893 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
8894 @enumerate
8895 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
8896 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8897 @end enumerate
8898
8899 The Tcl equal is this:
8900
8901 @enumerate
8902 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
8903 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8904 @end enumerate
8905
8906 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
8907 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
8908
8909 @section Tcl Rule #1b
8910 There is a second pair of rules.
8911 @enumerate
8912 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
8913 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
8914 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
8915 in Tcl.
8916 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8917 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
8918 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
8919 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
8920 @end enumerate
8921
8922 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
8923 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
8924 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
8925 Everything is a string}
8926
8927 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
8928 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
8929 difference is subtle.
8930 @enumerate
8931 @item Parse Time
8932 @item Evaluation Time
8933 @end enumerate
8934
8935 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
8936 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
8937 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
8938
8939 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
8940 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
8941 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
8942 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
8943
8944 @itemize @bullet
8945 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
8946 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
8947 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
8948 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
8949 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
8950 @example
8951 # bash example
8952 X=`date`
8953 echo "The Date is: $X"
8954 # Tcl example
8955 set X [date]
8956 puts "The Date is: $X"
8957 @end example
8958 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
8959 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
8960 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
8961 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
8962 is a string}
8963 @example
8964 set x "Dinner"
8965 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
8966 @end example
8967 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
8968 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
8969 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
8970 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
8971 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
8972 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
8973 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
8974 @end itemize
8975
8976 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
8977
8978 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
8979
8980 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
8981
8982 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
8983 the normal way.
8984
8985 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
8986 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
8987 line is immedatly executed.
8988
8989 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
8990 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
8991
8992 @subsection Command Execution
8993
8994 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
8995 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
8996 control flow operators.
8997
8998 Commands are executed like this:
8999
9000 @enumerate
9001 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9002 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9003 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9004 @end enumerate
9005
9006 It sort of works like this:
9007 @example
9008 for(;;)@{
9009 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9010
9011 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9012
9013 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9014 @}
9015 @end example
9016
9017 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9018 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9019 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9020 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9021 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9022 ``LookupCommand()''
9023
9024 @subsection The FOR command
9025
9026 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9027 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9028 command just like any other command.
9029
9030 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9031 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9032 are:
9033
9034 @enumerate 0
9035 @item The ascii text 'for'
9036 @item The start text
9037 @item The test expression
9038 @item The next text
9039 @item The body text
9040 @end enumerate
9041
9042 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9043 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9044 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9045 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9046
9047 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9048 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9049
9050 @example
9051 int
9052 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9053 int *argc,
9054 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9055 @end example
9056
9057 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9058 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9059 still operates in the same basic way.
9060
9061 @subsection FOR command implementation
9062
9063 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9064 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9065
9066 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9067
9068 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9069
9070 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9071 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9072 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9073
9074 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9075 expression and returns a value.
9076
9077 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9078 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9079 @example
9080 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9081
9082 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9083
9084 int
9085 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9086 int argc,
9087 char **argv )
9088 @{
9089 if( argc != 5 )@{
9090 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9091 return ERROR;
9092 @}
9093
9094 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9095
9096 // Execute the start statement.
9097 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9098
9099 // Top of loop test
9100 for(;;)@{
9101 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9102 if( i == 0 )
9103 break;
9104
9105 // Execute the body
9106 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9107
9108 // Execute the LOOP part
9109 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9110 @}
9111
9112 // Return no error
9113 SetResult( interp, "" );
9114 return SUCCESS;
9115 @}
9116 @end example
9117
9118 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9119 in the same basic way.
9120
9121 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9122
9123 @subsection source and find commands
9124 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9125 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9126 @*Remember the parsing rules
9127 @enumerate
9128 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9129 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9130 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9131 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9132 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9133 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9134 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9135 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9136 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9137 @end enumerate
9138 @subsection format command
9139 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9140 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9141 @b{sprintf()}.
9142 @b{Example}
9143 @example
9144 set x 6
9145 set y 7
9146 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9147 @end example
9148 @enumerate
9149 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9150 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9151 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9152 @* Refer to Rule #1
9153 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9154 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9155 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9156 @end enumerate
9157 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9158 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9159 @example
9160 #1 Good
9161 proc someproc @{@} @{
9162 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9163 @}
9164 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9165 #2 Good - no variables
9166 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9167 #3 Good Curly Braces
9168 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9169 puts "Time: [date]"
9170 @}
9171 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9172 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9173 @end example
9174 @enumerate
9175 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9176 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9177 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9178 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9179 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9180 command.
9181 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9182 @*There are 4 examples:
9183 @enumerate
9184 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9185 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9186 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9187 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9188 @end enumerate
9189
9190 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9191 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9192 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9193
9194 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9195 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9196 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9197 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9198 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9199 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9200 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9201 @end enumerate
9202 @subsection Global Variables
9203 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9204 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9205 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9206 @example
9207 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9208 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9209 global x #Global variable X
9210 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9211 @}
9212 @end example
9213 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9214 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9215 @example
9216 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9217 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9218 # Create var name
9219 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9220 # Make it a global
9221 global $vn
9222 # Set it.
9223 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9224 @}
9225 @end example
9226 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9227 @example
9228 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9229 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9230 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9231 @}
9232 @end example
9233
9234 @include fdl.texi
9235
9236 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9237 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9238 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9239 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9240 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9241 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9242
9243 @printindex cp
9244
9245 @node Command and Driver Index
9246 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9247 @printindex fn
9248
9249 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)